PR macros/7961:
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "gdbthread.h"
36 #include "target.h"
37 #include "language.h"
38 #include "gdb_string.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
41 #include "annotate.h"
42 #include "symfile.h"
43 #include "objfiles.h"
44 #include "source.h"
45 #include "linespec.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
47 #include "gdb.h"
48 #include "ui-out.h"
49 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
50 #include "gdb_assert.h"
51 #include "block.h"
52 #include "solib.h"
53 #include "solist.h"
54 #include "observer.h"
55 #include "exceptions.h"
56 #include "memattr.h"
57 #include "ada-lang.h"
58 #include "top.h"
59 #include "valprint.h"
60 #include "jit.h"
61 #include "xml-syscall.h"
62 #include "parser-defs.h"
63 #include "gdb_regex.h"
64 #include "probe.h"
65 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
66 #include "continuations.h"
67 #include "stack.h"
68 #include "skip.h"
69 #include "gdb_regex.h"
70 #include "ax-gdb.h"
71 #include "dummy-frame.h"
72
73 /* readline include files */
74 #include "readline/readline.h"
75 #include "readline/history.h"
76
77 /* readline defines this. */
78 #undef savestring
79
80 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
81 #include "python/python.h"
82
83 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
84
85 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
86
87 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
88
89 static void enable_count_command (char *, int);
90
91 static void disable_command (char *, int);
92
93 static void enable_command (char *, int);
94
95 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*) (struct breakpoint *,
96 void *),
97 void *);
98
99 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
100
101 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
102
103 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
104
105 static void create_sals_from_address_default (char **,
106 struct linespec_result *,
107 enum bptype, char *,
108 char **);
109
110 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
111 struct linespec_result *,
112 struct linespec_sals *,
113 char *, char *, enum bptype,
114 enum bpdisp, int, int,
115 int,
116 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
117 int, int, int, unsigned);
118
119 static void decode_linespec_default (struct breakpoint *, char **,
120 struct symtabs_and_lines *);
121
122 static void clear_command (char *, int);
123
124 static void catch_command (char *, int);
125
126 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
127
128 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
129
130 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
131
132 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
133 enum bptype,
134 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
135 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
136 const struct symtab_and_line *);
137
138 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
139 static. */
140 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
141 struct symtab_and_line,
142 enum bptype,
143 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
144
145 static struct breakpoint *
146 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
147 enum bptype type,
148 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops);
149
150 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
151
152 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
153 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
154 enum bptype bptype);
155
156 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
157 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
158 struct obj_section *, int);
159
160 static int breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1,
161 CORE_ADDR addr1,
162 struct address_space *aspace2,
163 CORE_ADDR addr2);
164
165 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
166 struct bp_location *loc2);
167
168 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
169 struct address_space *aspace,
170 CORE_ADDR addr);
171
172 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
173
174 static void watchpoints_info (char *, int);
175
176 static int breakpoint_1 (char *, int,
177 int (*) (const struct breakpoint *));
178
179 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
180
181 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
182
183 static void commands_command (char *, int);
184
185 static void condition_command (char *, int);
186
187 typedef enum
188 {
189 mark_inserted,
190 mark_uninserted
191 }
192 insertion_state_t;
193
194 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
195 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
196
197 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
198
199 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
200
201 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
202
203 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
204
205 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
206
207 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
208 enum bptype type,
209 int *other_type_used);
210
211 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
212
213 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
214
215 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
216 int count);
217
218 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
219
220 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
221
222 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
223
224 static char *ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg);
225
226 static void catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event,
227 char *arg, int tempflag, int from_tty);
228
229 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
230
231 static void detach_single_step_breakpoints (void);
232
233 static int single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *,
234 CORE_ADDR pc);
235
236 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
237 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
238 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
239
240 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
241
242 static void update_global_location_list (int);
243
244 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
245
246 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
247
248 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
249
250 static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
251
252 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
253
254 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
255
256 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
257
258 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
259
260 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
261
262 static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
263
264 static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
265
266 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
267 otherwise. */
268
269 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
270
271 static void init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
272 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
273 char *cond_string,
274 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops);
275
276 /* The abstract base class all breakpoint_ops structures inherit
277 from. */
278 static struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops;
279
280 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
281 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
282 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
283 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
284
285 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
286 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
287
288 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
289 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
290
291 /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception class type. */
292 static struct breakpoint_ops longjmp_breakpoint_ops;
293
294 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
295 breakpoints. */
296 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
297
298 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
299 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
300
301 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
302 static struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
303
304 /* A reference-counted struct command_line. This lets multiple
305 breakpoints share a single command list. */
306 struct counted_command_line
307 {
308 /* The reference count. */
309 int refc;
310
311 /* The command list. */
312 struct command_line *commands;
313 };
314
315 struct command_line *
316 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
317 {
318 return b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
319 }
320
321 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
322 current breakpoint. */
323
324 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
325
326 const char *
327 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
328 {
329 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
330 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
331 a breakpoint. */
332 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
333
334 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
335 }
336
337 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
338 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
339 if such is available. */
340 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
341
342 static void
343 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
344 struct cmd_list_element *c,
345 const char *value)
346 {
347 fprintf_filtered (file,
348 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
349 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
350 value);
351 }
352
353 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
354 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
355 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
356 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
357 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
358 static void
359 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
360 struct cmd_list_element *c,
361 const char *value)
362 {
363 fprintf_filtered (file,
364 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
365 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
366 value);
367 }
368
369 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
370 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
371 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
372 use hardware breakpoints. */
373 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
374 static void
375 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
376 struct cmd_list_element *c,
377 const char *value)
378 {
379 fprintf_filtered (file,
380 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
381 value);
382 }
383
384 /* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
385 stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints. If off, gdb
386 will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
387 will remove breakpoints upon stop. If auto, GDB will behave as ON
388 if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
389
390 static const char always_inserted_auto[] = "auto";
391 static const char always_inserted_on[] = "on";
392 static const char always_inserted_off[] = "off";
393 static const char *const always_inserted_enums[] = {
394 always_inserted_auto,
395 always_inserted_off,
396 always_inserted_on,
397 NULL
398 };
399 static const char *always_inserted_mode = always_inserted_auto;
400 static void
401 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
402 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
403 {
404 if (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto)
405 fprintf_filtered (file,
406 _("Always inserted breakpoint "
407 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
408 value,
409 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
410 else
411 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
412 value);
413 }
414
415 int
416 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
417 {
418 return (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_on
419 || (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto && non_stop));
420 }
421
422 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
423
424 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
425 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
426 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
427 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
428 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
429 condition_evaluation_auto,
430 condition_evaluation_host,
431 condition_evaluation_target,
432 NULL
433 };
434
435 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
436 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
437
438 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
439 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
440 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
441
442 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
443 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
444 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
445 evaluation mode. */
446
447 static const char *
448 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
449 {
450 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
451 {
452 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
453 return condition_evaluation_target;
454 else
455 return condition_evaluation_host;
456 }
457 else
458 return mode;
459 }
460
461 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
462
463 static const char *
464 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
465 {
466 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
467 }
468
469 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
470 otherwise. */
471
472 static int
473 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
474 {
475 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
476
477 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
478 }
479
480 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
481
482 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
483 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
484
485 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
486 static int overlay_events_enabled;
487
488 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
489 int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
490
491 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
492 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
493 current breakpoint. */
494
495 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
496
497 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
498 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
499 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
500 B = TMP)
501
502 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
503 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
504 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
505
506 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
507 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
508 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
509 BP_TMP++)
510
511 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
512 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
513 to where the loop should start from.
514 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
515 appropriate location to start with. */
516
517 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
518 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
519 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
520 BP_LOCP_START \
521 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count \
522 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
523 BP_LOCP_TMP++)
524
525 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
526
527 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
528 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
529 if (is_tracepoint (B))
530
531 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
532
533 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
534
535 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
536
537 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
538
539 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
540
541 static unsigned bp_location_count;
542
543 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
544 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid
545 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
546 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for
547 an address you need to read. */
548
549 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
550
551 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
552 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
553 BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
554 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to
555 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
556
557 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
558
559 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
560 from bp_location array, but for which a hit may still be reported
561 by a target. */
562 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
563
564 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
565
566 static int breakpoint_count;
567
568 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
569 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
570 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
571 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
572 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
573
574 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
575
576 static int tracepoint_count;
577
578 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
579 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
580 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
581
582 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
583 static int
584 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
585 {
586 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
587 }
588
589 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
590
591 static void
592 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
593 {
594 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
595 breakpoint_count = num;
596 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
597 }
598
599 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
600 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
601 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
602
603 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
604 breakpoint made. */
605
606 void
607 start_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
608 {
609 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
610 }
611
612 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
613 breakpoint made. */
614
615 void
616 end_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
617 {
618 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
619 }
620
621 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
622
623 void
624 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
625 {
626 struct breakpoint *b;
627
628 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
629 b->hit_count = 0;
630 }
631
632 /* Allocate a new counted_command_line with reference count of 1.
633 The new structure owns COMMANDS. */
634
635 static struct counted_command_line *
636 alloc_counted_command_line (struct command_line *commands)
637 {
638 struct counted_command_line *result
639 = xmalloc (sizeof (struct counted_command_line));
640
641 result->refc = 1;
642 result->commands = commands;
643 return result;
644 }
645
646 /* Increment reference count. This does nothing if CMD is NULL. */
647
648 static void
649 incref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line *cmd)
650 {
651 if (cmd)
652 ++cmd->refc;
653 }
654
655 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
656 destroy the counted_command_line. Sets *CMDP to NULL. This does
657 nothing if *CMDP is NULL. */
658
659 static void
660 decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
661 {
662 if (*cmdp)
663 {
664 if (--(*cmdp)->refc == 0)
665 {
666 free_command_lines (&(*cmdp)->commands);
667 xfree (*cmdp);
668 }
669 *cmdp = NULL;
670 }
671 }
672
673 /* A cleanup function that calls decref_counted_command_line. */
674
675 static void
676 do_cleanup_counted_command_line (void *arg)
677 {
678 decref_counted_command_line (arg);
679 }
680
681 /* Create a cleanup that calls decref_counted_command_line on the
682 argument. */
683
684 static struct cleanup *
685 make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
686 {
687 return make_cleanup (do_cleanup_counted_command_line, cmdp);
688 }
689
690 \f
691 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
692 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
693
694 struct breakpoint *
695 get_breakpoint (int num)
696 {
697 struct breakpoint *b;
698
699 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
700 if (b->number == num)
701 return b;
702
703 return NULL;
704 }
705
706 \f
707
708 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
709 evaluating conditions on its side. */
710
711 static void
712 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
713 {
714 struct bp_location *loc;
715
716 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
717 evaluating conditions and if the user has
718 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
719 side. */
720 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
721 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
722 return;
723
724 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
725 return;
726
727 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
728 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
729 }
730
731 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
732 evaluating conditions on its side. */
733
734 static void
735 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
736 {
737 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
738 evaluating conditions and if the user has
739 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
740 side. */
741 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
742 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
743
744 return;
745
746 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
747 return;
748
749 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
750 }
751
752 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
753 condition_evaluation_mode. */
754
755 static void
756 set_condition_evaluation_mode (char *args, int from_tty,
757 struct cmd_list_element *c)
758 {
759 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
760
761 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
762 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
763 {
764 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
765 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
766 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
767 return;
768 }
769
770 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
771 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
772
773 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
774 settings was "auto". */
775 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
776
777 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
778 if (new_mode != old_mode)
779 {
780 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
781 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
782 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
783
784 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
785 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
786 */
787
788 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
789 {
790 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
791 target. */
792 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
793 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
794 }
795 else
796 {
797 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
798 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
799 target knows about. */
800 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
801 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
802 loc->needs_update = 1;
803 }
804
805 /* Do the update. */
806 update_global_location_list (1);
807 }
808
809 return;
810 }
811
812 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
813 what "auto" is translating to. */
814
815 static void
816 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
817 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
818 {
819 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
820 fprintf_filtered (file,
821 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
822 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
823 value,
824 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
825 else
826 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
827 value);
828 }
829
830 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
831 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
832 the more general bp_location_compare function. */
833
834 static int
835 bp_location_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
836 {
837 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
838 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
839
840 if (a->address == b->address)
841 return 0;
842 else
843 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
844 }
845
846 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
847 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
848 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
849 return NULL. */
850
851 static struct bp_location **
852 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
853 {
854 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
855 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
856 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
857
858 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
859 memset (&dummy_loc, 0, sizeof (struct bp_location));
860 dummy_loc.address = address;
861
862 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
863 locp_found = bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_location, bp_location_count,
864 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
865 bp_location_compare_addrs);
866
867 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
868 if (locp_found == NULL)
869 return NULL;
870
871 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
872 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
873 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_location
874 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
875 locp_found--;
876
877 return locp_found;
878 }
879
880 void
881 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, char *exp,
882 int from_tty)
883 {
884 xfree (b->cond_string);
885 b->cond_string = NULL;
886
887 if (is_watchpoint (b))
888 {
889 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
890
891 xfree (w->cond_exp);
892 w->cond_exp = NULL;
893 }
894 else
895 {
896 struct bp_location *loc;
897
898 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
899 {
900 xfree (loc->cond);
901 loc->cond = NULL;
902
903 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
904 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
905 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
906 }
907 }
908
909 if (*exp == 0)
910 {
911 if (from_tty)
912 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
913 }
914 else
915 {
916 char *arg = exp;
917
918 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
919 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
920 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
921 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
922
923 if (is_watchpoint (b))
924 {
925 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
926
927 innermost_block = NULL;
928 arg = exp;
929 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
930 if (*arg)
931 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
932 w->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
933 }
934 else
935 {
936 struct bp_location *loc;
937
938 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
939 {
940 arg = exp;
941 loc->cond =
942 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
943 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
944 if (*arg)
945 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
946 }
947 }
948 }
949 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
950
951 breakpoints_changed ();
952 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
953 }
954
955 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
956
957 static VEC (char_ptr) *
958 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd, char *text, char *word)
959 {
960 char *space;
961
962 text = skip_spaces (text);
963 space = skip_to_space (text);
964 if (*space == '\0')
965 {
966 int len;
967 struct breakpoint *b;
968 VEC (char_ptr) *result = NULL;
969
970 if (text[0] == '$')
971 {
972 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
973 if (isdigit (text[1]))
974 return NULL;
975 return complete_internalvar (&text[1]);
976 }
977
978 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
979 len = strlen (text);
980
981 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
982 {
983 int single = b->loc->next == NULL;
984 struct bp_location *loc;
985 int count = 1;
986
987 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
988 {
989 char location[50];
990
991 if (single)
992 sprintf (location, "%d", b->number);
993 else
994 sprintf (location, "%d.%d", b->number, count);
995
996 if (strncmp (location, text, len) == 0)
997 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, result, xstrdup (location));
998
999 ++count;
1000 }
1001 }
1002
1003 return result;
1004 }
1005
1006 /* We're completing the expression part. */
1007 text = skip_spaces (space);
1008 return expression_completer (cmd, text, word);
1009 }
1010
1011 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
1012
1013 static void
1014 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1015 {
1016 struct breakpoint *b;
1017 char *p;
1018 int bnum;
1019
1020 if (arg == 0)
1021 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
1022
1023 p = arg;
1024 bnum = get_number (&p);
1025 if (bnum == 0)
1026 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
1027
1028 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1029 if (b->number == bnum)
1030 {
1031 /* Check if this breakpoint has a Python object assigned to
1032 it, and if it has a definition of the "stop"
1033 method. This method and conditions entered into GDB from
1034 the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
1035 if (b->py_bp_object
1036 && gdbpy_breakpoint_has_py_cond (b->py_bp_object))
1037 error (_("Cannot set a condition where a Python 'stop' "
1038 "method has been defined in the breakpoint."));
1039 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
1040
1041 if (is_breakpoint (b))
1042 update_global_location_list (1);
1043
1044 return;
1045 }
1046
1047 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
1048 }
1049
1050 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1051 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1052 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1053
1054 static void
1055 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1056 {
1057 struct command_line *c;
1058
1059 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1060 {
1061 int i;
1062
1063 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1064 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1065 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1066
1067 for (i = 0; i < c->body_count; ++i)
1068 check_no_tracepoint_commands ((c->body_list)[i]);
1069
1070 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1071 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1072 command directly. */
1073 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1074 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1075
1076 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1077 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1078 }
1079 }
1080
1081 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1082
1083 static int
1084 is_tracepoint_type (enum bptype type)
1085 {
1086 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1087 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1088 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1089 }
1090
1091 int
1092 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1093 {
1094 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1095 }
1096
1097 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1098 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1099 found. */
1100
1101 static void
1102 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1103 struct command_line *commands)
1104 {
1105 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1106 {
1107 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1108 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1109 while-stepping element, and that while-stepping's body has
1110 valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping. */
1111 struct command_line *c;
1112 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1113 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1114 {
1115 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1116 {
1117 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1118 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1119 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1120 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1121 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1122 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1123
1124 if (while_stepping)
1125 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1126 "can be used only once"));
1127 else
1128 while_stepping = c;
1129 }
1130 }
1131 if (while_stepping)
1132 {
1133 struct command_line *c2;
1134
1135 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_count == 1);
1136 c2 = while_stepping->body_list[0];
1137 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1138 {
1139 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1140 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1141 }
1142 }
1143 }
1144 else
1145 {
1146 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1147 }
1148 }
1149
1150 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1151 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1152
1153 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
1154 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1155 {
1156 struct breakpoint *b;
1157 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
1158 struct bp_location *loc;
1159
1160 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1161 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1162 {
1163 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1164 if (loc->address == addr)
1165 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
1166 }
1167
1168 return found;
1169 }
1170
1171 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1172 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1173
1174 void
1175 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1176 struct command_line *commands)
1177 {
1178 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands);
1179
1180 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1181 b->commands = alloc_counted_command_line (commands);
1182 breakpoints_changed ();
1183 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1184 }
1185
1186 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1187 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1188 commands. */
1189
1190 void
1191 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1192 {
1193 int old_silent = b->silent;
1194
1195 b->silent = silent;
1196 if (old_silent != silent)
1197 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1198 }
1199
1200 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1201 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1202
1203 void
1204 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1205 {
1206 int old_thread = b->thread;
1207
1208 b->thread = thread;
1209 if (old_thread != thread)
1210 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1211 }
1212
1213 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1214 breakpoint work for any task. */
1215
1216 void
1217 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1218 {
1219 int old_task = b->task;
1220
1221 b->task = task;
1222 if (old_task != task)
1223 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1224 }
1225
1226 void
1227 check_tracepoint_command (char *line, void *closure)
1228 {
1229 struct breakpoint *b = closure;
1230
1231 validate_actionline (&line, b);
1232 }
1233
1234 /* A structure used to pass information through
1235 map_breakpoint_numbers. */
1236
1237 struct commands_info
1238 {
1239 /* True if the command was typed at a tty. */
1240 int from_tty;
1241
1242 /* The breakpoint range spec. */
1243 char *arg;
1244
1245 /* Non-NULL if the body of the commands are being read from this
1246 already-parsed command. */
1247 struct command_line *control;
1248
1249 /* The command lines read from the user, or NULL if they have not
1250 yet been read. */
1251 struct counted_command_line *cmd;
1252 };
1253
1254 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that sets the commands for
1255 commands_command. */
1256
1257 static void
1258 do_map_commands_command (struct breakpoint *b, void *data)
1259 {
1260 struct commands_info *info = data;
1261
1262 if (info->cmd == NULL)
1263 {
1264 struct command_line *l;
1265
1266 if (info->control != NULL)
1267 l = copy_command_lines (info->control->body_list[0]);
1268 else
1269 {
1270 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1271 char *str;
1272
1273 str = xstrprintf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1274 "%s, one per line."),
1275 info->arg);
1276
1277 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, str);
1278
1279 l = read_command_lines (str,
1280 info->from_tty, 1,
1281 (is_tracepoint (b)
1282 ? check_tracepoint_command : 0),
1283 b);
1284
1285 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1286 }
1287
1288 info->cmd = alloc_counted_command_line (l);
1289 }
1290
1291 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1292 do anything. */
1293 if (b->commands != info->cmd)
1294 {
1295 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, info->cmd->commands);
1296 incref_counted_command_line (info->cmd);
1297 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1298 b->commands = info->cmd;
1299 breakpoints_changed ();
1300 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1301 }
1302 }
1303
1304 static void
1305 commands_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
1306 struct command_line *control)
1307 {
1308 struct cleanup *cleanups;
1309 struct commands_info info;
1310
1311 info.from_tty = from_tty;
1312 info.control = control;
1313 info.cmd = NULL;
1314 /* If we read command lines from the user, then `info' will hold an
1315 extra reference to the commands that we must clean up. */
1316 cleanups = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&info.cmd);
1317
1318 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1319 {
1320 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1321 arg = xstrprintf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1322 breakpoint_count);
1323 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1324 arg = xstrprintf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1325 else
1326 {
1327 /* So that we don't try to free the incoming non-NULL
1328 argument in the cleanup below. Mapping breakpoint
1329 numbers will fail in this case. */
1330 arg = NULL;
1331 }
1332 }
1333 else
1334 /* The command loop has some static state, so we need to preserve
1335 our argument. */
1336 arg = xstrdup (arg);
1337
1338 if (arg != NULL)
1339 make_cleanup (xfree, arg);
1340
1341 info.arg = arg;
1342
1343 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_commands_command, &info);
1344
1345 if (info.cmd == NULL)
1346 error (_("No breakpoints specified."));
1347
1348 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1349 }
1350
1351 static void
1352 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1353 {
1354 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1355 }
1356
1357 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1358 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1359
1360 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1361 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1362 enum command_control_type
1363 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1364 {
1365 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1366 return simple_control;
1367 }
1368
1369 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1370
1371 static int
1372 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1373 {
1374 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1375 return 0;
1376 if (!bl->inserted)
1377 return 0;
1378 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1379 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1380 return 0;
1381 return 1;
1382 }
1383
1384 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1385 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1386
1387 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1388 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1389 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1390
1391 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1392 bl->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1393 up to bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1394 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1395 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1396 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1397 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1398 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
1399 and:
1400 bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1401
1402 void
1403 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1404 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1405 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1406 {
1407 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1408 search. */
1409 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1410
1411 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1412 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1413 report higher one. */
1414
1415 bc_l = 0;
1416 bc_r = bp_location_count;
1417 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1418 {
1419 struct bp_location *bl;
1420
1421 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1422 bl = bp_location[bc];
1423
1424 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1425 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1426 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1427 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1428
1429 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1430 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1431 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1432
1433 if ((bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1434 >= bl->address)
1435 && (bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1436 <= memaddr))
1437 bc_l = bc;
1438 else
1439 bc_r = bc;
1440 }
1441
1442 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1443 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1444 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1445 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1446 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1447 B:
1448
1449 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1450
1451 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1452 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1453 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1454 and L2. */
1455 while (bc_l > 0
1456 && bp_location[bc_l]->address == bp_location[bc_l - 1]->address)
1457 bc_l--;
1458
1459 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1460
1461 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
1462 {
1463 struct bp_location *bl = bp_location[bc];
1464 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1465 int bp_size = 0;
1466 int bptoffset = 0;
1467
1468 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1469 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1470 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1471 bl->owner->number);
1472
1473 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1474 content. */
1475
1476 if (bl->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1477 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1478 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max))
1479 break;
1480
1481 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1482 continue;
1483 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->target_info.placed_address_space, 0,
1484 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1485 continue;
1486
1487 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1488 we need to copy. */
1489 bp_addr = bl->target_info.placed_address;
1490 bp_size = bl->target_info.shadow_len;
1491
1492 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1493 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we
1494 are reading. */
1495 continue;
1496
1497 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1498 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1499 reading. */
1500 continue;
1501
1502 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1503 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1504 {
1505 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1506 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1507 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1508 bp_addr = memaddr;
1509 }
1510
1511 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1512 {
1513 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1514 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1515 }
1516
1517 if (readbuf != NULL)
1518 {
1519 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with
1520 the shadow_contents buffer. */
1521 gdb_assert (bl->target_info.shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1522 || readbuf >= (bl->target_info.shadow_contents
1523 + bl->target_info.shadow_len));
1524
1525 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1526 shadow. */
1527 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1528 bl->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1529 }
1530 else
1531 {
1532 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = bl->gdbarch;
1533 const unsigned char *bp;
1534 CORE_ADDR placed_address = bl->target_info.placed_address;
1535 unsigned placed_size = bl->target_info.placed_size;
1536
1537 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1538 memcpy (bl->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1539 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1540
1541 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1542 address. */
1543 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &placed_address, &placed_size);
1544
1545 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1546 breakpoint's INSN. */
1547 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1548 }
1549 }
1550 }
1551 \f
1552
1553 /* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware
1554 breakpoint. */
1555
1556 int
1557 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1558 {
1559 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1560 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1561 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1562 }
1563
1564 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1565
1566 static int
1567 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1568 {
1569 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1570 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1571 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1572 }
1573
1574 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1575 software. */
1576
1577 int
1578 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1579 {
1580 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1581 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1582 }
1583
1584 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1585 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1586 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1587 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1588 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1589 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1590 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1591 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1592
1593 static int
1594 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1595 {
1596 return (b->base.pspace == current_program_space
1597 && (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1598 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1599 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))));
1600 }
1601
1602 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1603 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1604
1605 static void
1606 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1607 {
1608 struct breakpoint *b = &w->base;
1609
1610 if (b->related_breakpoint != b)
1611 {
1612 gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1613 gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == b);
1614 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1615 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
1616 b->related_breakpoint = b;
1617 }
1618 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1619 }
1620
1621 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1622 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1623 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1624 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1625 in b->loc->cond.
1626 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1627
1628 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1629 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1630 it.
1631
1632 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1633 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1634 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1635 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1636 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1637 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1638 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1639 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1640
1641 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1642 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1643 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1644 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1645 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1646 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1647 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1648 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1649 not changed.
1650
1651 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1652 hardware watchpoints:
1653
1654 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1655 called several times when GDB stops.
1656
1657 [linux]
1658 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1659 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1660 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1661 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1662 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1663 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1664 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1665 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1666 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1667 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1668 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1669
1670 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1671 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1672
1673 static void
1674 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1675 {
1676 int within_current_scope;
1677 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1678 int frame_saved;
1679
1680 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1681 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1682 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1683 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1684 return;
1685
1686 if (b->base.disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1687 return;
1688
1689 frame_saved = 0;
1690
1691 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1692 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1693 within_current_scope = 1;
1694 else
1695 {
1696 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1697 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1698 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1699
1700 /* If we're in a function epilogue, unwinding may not work
1701 properly, so do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1702 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1703 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1704 return;
1705
1706 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1707 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1708 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1709 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1710 selected frame. */
1711 frame_saved = 1;
1712 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1713
1714 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1715 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1716 if (within_current_scope)
1717 select_frame (fi);
1718 }
1719
1720 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1721 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1722 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1723 b->base.loc = NULL;
1724
1725 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1726 {
1727 char *s;
1728
1729 if (b->exp)
1730 {
1731 xfree (b->exp);
1732 b->exp = NULL;
1733 }
1734 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1735 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1736 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1737 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1738 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1739 be completely different objects. */
1740 value_free (b->val);
1741 b->val = NULL;
1742 b->val_valid = 0;
1743
1744 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1745 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1746 locations (re)created below. */
1747 if (b->base.cond_string != NULL)
1748 {
1749 if (b->cond_exp != NULL)
1750 {
1751 xfree (b->cond_exp);
1752 b->cond_exp = NULL;
1753 }
1754
1755 s = b->base.cond_string;
1756 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1757 }
1758 }
1759
1760 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1761 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1762 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1763 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1764 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1765 if ( !target_has_execution)
1766 {
1767 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1768 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1769 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1770 }
1771 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1772 {
1773 int pc = 0;
1774 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1775 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1776
1777 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain);
1778
1779 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1780 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1781 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1782 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1783 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1784 watchpoints. */
1785 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base))
1786 {
1787 b->val = v;
1788 b->val_valid = 1;
1789 }
1790
1791 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1792
1793 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1794 for (v = val_chain; v; v = value_next (v))
1795 {
1796 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1797 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1798 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1799 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1800 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1801 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1802 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1803 {
1804 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1805
1806 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1807 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1808 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1809 if (v == result
1810 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1811 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1812 {
1813 CORE_ADDR addr;
1814 int len, type;
1815 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1816
1817 addr = value_address (v);
1818 len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1819 type = hw_write;
1820 if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1821 type = hw_read;
1822 else if (b->base.type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1823 type = hw_access;
1824
1825 loc = allocate_bp_location (&b->base);
1826 for (tmp = &(b->base.loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1827 ;
1828 *tmp = loc;
1829 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1830
1831 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1832 loc->address = addr;
1833 loc->length = len;
1834 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1835 }
1836 }
1837 }
1838
1839 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
1840 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
1841 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
1842 is started. */
1843 if (reparse)
1844 {
1845 int reg_cnt;
1846 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
1847 struct bp_location *bl;
1848
1849 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1850
1851 if (reg_cnt)
1852 {
1853 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
1854 enum bptype type;
1855
1856 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
1857 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
1858 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
1859
1860 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
1861 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
1862 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
1863 this watchpoint in as well. */
1864
1865 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
1866 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
1867 hardware watchpoint type. */
1868 type = b->base.type;
1869 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
1870 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1871
1872 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
1873 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
1874 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
1875 through watch_command), so always account for it
1876 manually. */
1877
1878 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
1879 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (&b->base, type, &other_type_used);
1880
1881 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
1882 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (&b->base);
1883
1884 target_resources_ok
1885 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
1886 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1887 {
1888 int sw_mode = b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base);
1889
1890 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
1891 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
1892 "hardware watchpoint."));
1893 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
1894 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
1895 "resources for this watchpoint."));
1896
1897 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
1898 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
1899 }
1900 else
1901 {
1902 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
1903 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
1904 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
1905 nop. */
1906 b->base.type = type;
1907 }
1908 }
1909 else if (!b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base))
1910 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
1911 "read/access watchpoint."));
1912 else
1913 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
1914
1915 loc_type = (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
1916 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
1917 for (bl = b->base.loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
1918 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
1919 }
1920
1921 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1922 {
1923 next = value_next (v);
1924 if (v != b->val)
1925 value_free (v);
1926 }
1927
1928 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1929 above left it without any location set up. But,
1930 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1931 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1932 if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint && b->base.loc == NULL)
1933 {
1934 struct breakpoint *base = &b->base;
1935 base->loc = allocate_bp_location (base);
1936 base->loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1937 base->loc->address = -1;
1938 base->loc->length = -1;
1939 base->loc->watchpoint_type = -1;
1940 }
1941 }
1942 else if (!within_current_scope)
1943 {
1944 printf_filtered (_("\
1945 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
1946 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1947 b->base.number);
1948 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
1949 }
1950
1951 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1952 if (frame_saved)
1953 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1954 }
1955
1956
1957 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1958 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
1959 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
1960 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
1961 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
1962 static int
1963 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
1964 {
1965 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
1966 return 0;
1967
1968 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1969 return 0;
1970
1971 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
1972 return 0;
1973
1974 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
1975 return 0;
1976
1977 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1978 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
1979 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
1980 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
1981 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
1982 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
1983 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
1984 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
1985 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
1986 return 0;
1987
1988 return 1;
1989 }
1990
1991 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
1992 that the location is not duplicated. */
1993
1994 static int
1995 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
1996 {
1997 int result;
1998 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
1999
2000 bl->duplicate = 0;
2001 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2002 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2003 return result;
2004 }
2005
2006 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2007 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2008 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2009 any error during parsing. */
2010
2011 static struct agent_expr *
2012 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2013 {
2014 struct agent_expr *aexpr = NULL;
2015 struct cleanup *old_chain = NULL;
2016 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
2017
2018 if (!cond)
2019 return NULL;
2020
2021 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2022 that may show up. */
2023 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2024 {
2025 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2026 }
2027
2028 if (ex.reason < 0)
2029 {
2030 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2031 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2032 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2033 return NULL;
2034 }
2035
2036 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2037 return aexpr;
2038 }
2039
2040 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2041 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2042 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2043 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2044 one of them is true. */
2045
2046 static void
2047 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2048 {
2049 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2050 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2051 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2052 struct bp_location *loc;
2053
2054 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2055 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2056 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2057 side. */
2058 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2059 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2060 return;
2061
2062 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2063 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2064 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2065 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2066 response back to GDB. */
2067 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2068 {
2069 loc = (*loc2p);
2070 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2071 {
2072 if (modified)
2073 {
2074 struct agent_expr *aexpr;
2075
2076 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2077 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2078 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2079 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2080 aexpr = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address, loc->cond);
2081 loc->cond_bytecode = aexpr;
2082
2083 /* Check if we managed to parse the conditional expression
2084 correctly. If not, we will not send this condition
2085 to the target. */
2086 if (aexpr)
2087 continue;
2088 }
2089
2090 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2091 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2092 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2093 {
2094 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2095 break;
2096 }
2097 }
2098 }
2099
2100 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2101 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2102 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2103
2104 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2105 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2106 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2107 {
2108 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2109 {
2110 loc = (*loc2p);
2111 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2112 {
2113 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2114 located. */
2115 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2116 return;
2117
2118 free_agent_expr (loc->cond_bytecode);
2119 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
2120 }
2121 }
2122 }
2123
2124 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2125 for this location's address. */
2126 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2127 {
2128 loc = (*loc2p);
2129 if (loc->cond
2130 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2131 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2132 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2133 && loc->enabled)
2134 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later to send the
2135 conditions to the target. */
2136 VEC_safe_push (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.conditions,
2137 loc->cond_bytecode);
2138 }
2139
2140 return;
2141 }
2142
2143 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2144 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2145 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2146 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2147 -1 for failure.
2148
2149 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2150 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2151 static int
2152 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2153 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2154 int *disabled_breaks,
2155 int *hw_breakpoint_error)
2156 {
2157 int val = 0;
2158
2159 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2160 return 0;
2161
2162 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2163 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2164 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2165 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2166 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2167 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2168 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2169 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2170 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2171 bl->target_info.placed_address = bl->address;
2172 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2173 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2174
2175 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2176 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2177 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2178 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2179
2180 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2181 {
2182 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2183 /* Reset the condition modification marker. */
2184 bl->needs_update = 0;
2185 }
2186
2187 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2188 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2189 {
2190 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2191 {
2192 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2193 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2194 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2195
2196 Two important cases are:
2197 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2198 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2199 hardware breakpoint.
2200 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2201 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2202 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2203 so we undo.
2204
2205 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2206 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2207 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2208 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2209 gdb. */
2210 struct mem_region *mr
2211 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.placed_address);
2212
2213 if (mr)
2214 {
2215 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2216 {
2217 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2218
2219 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2220 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2221 else
2222 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2223
2224 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2225 {
2226 static int said = 0;
2227
2228 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2229 if (!said)
2230 {
2231 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2232 _("Note: automatically using "
2233 "hardware breakpoints for "
2234 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2235 said = 1;
2236 }
2237 }
2238 }
2239 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2240 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2241 warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint "
2242 "at readonly address %s"),
2243 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2244 }
2245 }
2246
2247 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2248 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2249 || bl->section == NULL
2250 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2251 {
2252 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2253
2254 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2255 }
2256 else
2257 {
2258 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2259 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2260 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2261 {
2262 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2263 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2264 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2265 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2266 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2267 bl->owner->number);
2268 else
2269 {
2270 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2271 bl->section);
2272 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2273 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2274 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
2275 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2276 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2277 if (val != 0)
2278 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2279 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2280 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2281 bl->owner->number);
2282 }
2283 }
2284 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2285 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2286 {
2287 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2288 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2289 }
2290 else
2291 {
2292 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2293 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2294 return 0;
2295 }
2296 }
2297
2298 if (val)
2299 {
2300 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2301 if (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address))
2302 {
2303 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2304 val = 0;
2305 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2306 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bl->owner);
2307 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2308 {
2309 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2310 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2311 bl->owner->number);
2312 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2313 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2314 "library breakpoints:\n");
2315 }
2316 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2317 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2318 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2319 }
2320 else
2321 {
2322 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2323 {
2324 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2325 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2326 "Cannot insert hardware "
2327 "breakpoint %d.\n",
2328 bl->owner->number);
2329 }
2330 else
2331 {
2332 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2333 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2334 bl->owner->number);
2335 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream,
2336 "Error accessing memory address ");
2337 fputs_filtered (paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
2338 tmp_error_stream);
2339 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream, ": %s.\n",
2340 safe_strerror (val));
2341 }
2342
2343 }
2344 }
2345 else
2346 bl->inserted = 1;
2347
2348 return val;
2349 }
2350
2351 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2352 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2353 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2354 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2355 {
2356 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2357 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2358
2359 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2360
2361 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2362 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2363 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2364 {
2365 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2366
2367 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2368 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2369 of this one. */
2370 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2371 if (loc != bl
2372 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2373 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2374 {
2375 bl->duplicate = 1;
2376 bl->inserted = 1;
2377 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2378 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2379 val = 0;
2380 break;
2381 }
2382
2383 if (val == 1)
2384 {
2385 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2386 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2387
2388 if (val)
2389 /* Back to the original value. */
2390 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2391 }
2392 }
2393
2394 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2395 }
2396
2397 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2398 {
2399 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2400 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2401
2402 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2403 if (val)
2404 {
2405 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2406
2407 if (val == 1)
2408 warning (_("\
2409 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2410 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2411 else
2412 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2413 }
2414
2415 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2416
2417 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2418 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2419 so just return success. */
2420 return 0;
2421 }
2422
2423 return 0;
2424 }
2425
2426 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2427 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2428 PSPACE anymore. */
2429
2430 void
2431 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2432 {
2433 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2434 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2435
2436 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2437 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2438 {
2439 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2440 delete_breakpoint (b);
2441 }
2442
2443 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2444 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2445 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2446 {
2447 struct bp_location *tmp;
2448
2449 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2450 {
2451 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2452 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2453 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2454 else
2455 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2456 if (tmp->next == loc)
2457 {
2458 tmp->next = loc->next;
2459 break;
2460 }
2461 }
2462 }
2463
2464 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2465 removed locations above. */
2466 update_global_location_list (0);
2467 }
2468
2469 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2470 Throws exception on any error.
2471 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2472 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2473 void
2474 insert_breakpoints (void)
2475 {
2476 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2477
2478 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2479 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2480 {
2481 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
2482
2483 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2484 }
2485
2486 update_global_location_list (1);
2487
2488 /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
2489 always_inserted_mode is not enabled. Explicitly insert them
2490 now. */
2491 if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
2492 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
2493 }
2494
2495 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
2496
2497 void
2498 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
2499 {
2500 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
2501
2502 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
2503 {
2504 callback (loc, NULL);
2505 }
2506 }
2507
2508 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
2509 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
2510 always-inserted mode. */
2511
2512 static void
2513 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
2514 {
2515 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2516 int error_flag = 0;
2517 int val = 0;
2518 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2519 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2520
2521 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
2522 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
2523
2524 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2525 there was an error. */
2526 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
2527
2528 save_current_space_and_thread ();
2529
2530 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2531 {
2532 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
2533 breakpoints. */
2534 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2535 continue;
2536
2537 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
2538 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
2539 deletion of breakpoints. */
2540 if (!bl->inserted || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2541 continue;
2542
2543 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2544
2545 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2546 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2547 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2548 insert breakpoints. */
2549 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
2550 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2551 continue;
2552
2553 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2554 &hw_breakpoint_error);
2555 if (val)
2556 error_flag = val;
2557 }
2558
2559 if (error_flag)
2560 {
2561 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
2562 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2563 }
2564
2565 do_cleanups (cleanups);
2566 }
2567
2568 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
2569
2570 static void
2571 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
2572 {
2573 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2574 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2575 int error_flag = 0;
2576 int val = 0;
2577 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2578 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2579
2580 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
2581 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
2582
2583 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2584 there was an error. */
2585 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
2586
2587 save_current_space_and_thread ();
2588
2589 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2590 {
2591 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2592 continue;
2593
2594 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
2595 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
2596 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2597 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
2598 && !valid_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
2599 continue;
2600
2601 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2602
2603 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2604 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2605 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2606 insert breakpoints. */
2607 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
2608 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2609 continue;
2610
2611 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2612 &hw_breakpoint_error);
2613 if (val)
2614 error_flag = val;
2615 }
2616
2617 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
2618 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
2619 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2620 {
2621 int some_failed = 0;
2622 struct bp_location *loc;
2623
2624 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2625 continue;
2626
2627 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2628 continue;
2629
2630 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2631 continue;
2632
2633 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2634 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
2635 {
2636 some_failed = 1;
2637 break;
2638 }
2639 if (some_failed)
2640 {
2641 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2642 if (loc->inserted)
2643 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
2644
2645 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2646 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2647 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
2648 bpt->number);
2649 error_flag = -1;
2650 }
2651 }
2652
2653 if (error_flag)
2654 {
2655 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
2656 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
2657 if (hw_breakpoint_error)
2658 {
2659 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2660 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
2661 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
2662 }
2663 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
2664 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2665 }
2666
2667 do_cleanups (cleanups);
2668 }
2669
2670 /* Used when the program stops.
2671 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
2672 removing a breakpoint location. */
2673
2674 int
2675 remove_breakpoints (void)
2676 {
2677 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2678 int val = 0;
2679
2680 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2681 {
2682 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
2683 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
2684 }
2685 return val;
2686 }
2687
2688 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
2689
2690 int
2691 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
2692 {
2693 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2694 int val;
2695 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
2696
2697 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2698 {
2699 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
2700 continue;
2701
2702 if (bl->inserted)
2703 {
2704 val = remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
2705 if (val != 0)
2706 return val;
2707 }
2708 }
2709 return 0;
2710 }
2711
2712 int
2713 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
2714 {
2715 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2716 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2717 int val;
2718 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream;
2719 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0;
2720 struct inferior *inf;
2721 struct thread_info *tp;
2722
2723 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
2724 if (tp == NULL)
2725 return 1;
2726
2727 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
2728 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
2729
2730 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
2731
2732 tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
2733 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
2734
2735 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2736 {
2737 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
2738 continue;
2739
2740 if (bl->inserted)
2741 {
2742 bl->inserted = 0;
2743 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &dummy1, &dummy2);
2744 if (val != 0)
2745 {
2746 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2747 return val;
2748 }
2749 }
2750 }
2751 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2752 return 0;
2753 }
2754
2755 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
2756
2757 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
2758 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
2759 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
2760 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
2761 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
2762 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
2763 static void
2764 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
2765 {
2766 if (internal)
2767 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
2768 else
2769 {
2770 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
2771 b->number = breakpoint_count;
2772 }
2773 }
2774
2775 static struct breakpoint *
2776 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
2777 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
2778 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
2779 {
2780 struct symtab_and_line sal;
2781 struct breakpoint *b;
2782
2783 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
2784
2785 sal.pc = address;
2786 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
2787 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
2788
2789 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
2790 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
2791 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
2792
2793 return b;
2794 }
2795
2796 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
2797 {
2798 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
2799 };
2800 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
2801
2802 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
2803 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
2804 {
2805 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
2806 struct minimal_symbol *overlay_msym;
2807
2808 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
2809 struct minimal_symbol *longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES];
2810
2811 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
2812 int longjmp_searched;
2813
2814 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). */
2815 VEC (probe_p) *longjmp_probes;
2816
2817 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
2818 struct minimal_symbol *terminate_msym;
2819
2820 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
2821 struct minimal_symbol *exception_msym;
2822
2823 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
2824 int exception_searched;
2825
2826 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). */
2827 VEC (probe_p) *exception_probes;
2828 };
2829
2830 static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key;
2831
2832 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
2833 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
2834
2835 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
2836
2837 static int
2838 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
2839 {
2840 return msym == &msym_not_found;
2841 }
2842
2843 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
2844 Allocate the data if necessary. */
2845
2846 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
2847 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
2848 {
2849 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
2850
2851 bp_objfile_data = objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key);
2852 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
2853 {
2854 bp_objfile_data = obstack_alloc (&objfile->objfile_obstack,
2855 sizeof (*bp_objfile_data));
2856
2857 memset (bp_objfile_data, 0, sizeof (*bp_objfile_data));
2858 set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data);
2859 }
2860 return bp_objfile_data;
2861 }
2862
2863 static void
2864 free_breakpoint_probes (struct objfile *obj, void *data)
2865 {
2866 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data = data;
2867
2868 VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes);
2869 VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->exception_probes);
2870 }
2871
2872 static void
2873 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
2874 {
2875 struct objfile *objfile;
2876 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
2877
2878 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
2879 {
2880 struct breakpoint *b;
2881 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
2882 CORE_ADDR addr;
2883
2884 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
2885
2886 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym))
2887 continue;
2888
2889 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym == NULL)
2890 {
2891 struct minimal_symbol *m;
2892
2893 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
2894 if (m == NULL)
2895 {
2896 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
2897 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = &msym_not_found;
2898 continue;
2899 }
2900 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
2901 }
2902
2903 addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
2904 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
2905 bp_overlay_event,
2906 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
2907 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
2908
2909 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
2910 {
2911 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
2912 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
2913 }
2914 else
2915 {
2916 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2917 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
2918 }
2919 }
2920 update_global_location_list (1);
2921 }
2922
2923 static void
2924 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
2925 {
2926 struct program_space *pspace;
2927 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2928
2929 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
2930
2931 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
2932 {
2933 struct objfile *objfile;
2934
2935 set_current_program_space (pspace);
2936
2937 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
2938 {
2939 int i;
2940 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
2941 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
2942
2943 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
2944 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
2945 continue;
2946
2947 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
2948
2949 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
2950 {
2951 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes
2952 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
2953 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
2954 }
2955
2956 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes != NULL)
2957 {
2958 int i;
2959 struct probe *probe;
2960 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
2961
2962 for (i = 0;
2963 VEC_iterate (probe_p,
2964 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes,
2965 i, probe);
2966 ++i)
2967 {
2968 struct breakpoint *b;
2969
2970 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, probe->address,
2971 bp_longjmp_master,
2972 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
2973 b->addr_string = xstrdup ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
2974 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2975 }
2976
2977 continue;
2978 }
2979
2980 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
2981 {
2982 struct breakpoint *b;
2983 const char *func_name;
2984 CORE_ADDR addr;
2985
2986 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]))
2987 continue;
2988
2989 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
2990 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] == NULL)
2991 {
2992 struct minimal_symbol *m;
2993
2994 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
2995 if (m == NULL)
2996 {
2997 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
2998 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = &msym_not_found;
2999 continue;
3000 }
3001 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3002 }
3003
3004 addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3005 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3006 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3007 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
3008 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3009 }
3010 }
3011 }
3012 update_global_location_list (1);
3013
3014 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3015 }
3016
3017 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3018 static void
3019 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3020 {
3021 struct program_space *pspace;
3022 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3023 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3024
3025 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3026
3027 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3028 {
3029 struct objfile *objfile;
3030 CORE_ADDR addr;
3031
3032 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3033
3034 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3035 {
3036 struct breakpoint *b;
3037 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3038
3039 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3040
3041 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym))
3042 continue;
3043
3044 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym == NULL)
3045 {
3046 struct minimal_symbol *m;
3047
3048 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3049 if (m == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m) != mst_text
3050 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m) != mst_file_text))
3051 {
3052 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3053 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = &msym_not_found;
3054 continue;
3055 }
3056 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3057 }
3058
3059 addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3060 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3061 bp_std_terminate_master,
3062 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3063 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
3064 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3065 }
3066 }
3067
3068 update_global_location_list (1);
3069
3070 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3071 }
3072
3073 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3074
3075 static void
3076 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3077 {
3078 struct objfile *objfile;
3079 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3080
3081 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3082 {
3083 struct breakpoint *b;
3084 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3085 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3086 CORE_ADDR addr;
3087
3088 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3089
3090 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3091 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3092 {
3093 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes
3094 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3095 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3096 }
3097
3098 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_probes != NULL)
3099 {
3100 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3101 int i;
3102 struct probe *probe;
3103
3104 for (i = 0;
3105 VEC_iterate (probe_p,
3106 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes,
3107 i, probe);
3108 ++i)
3109 {
3110 struct breakpoint *b;
3111
3112 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, probe->address,
3113 bp_exception_master,
3114 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3115 b->addr_string = xstrdup ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3116 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3117 }
3118
3119 continue;
3120 }
3121
3122 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3123
3124 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym))
3125 continue;
3126
3127 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3128
3129 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym == NULL)
3130 {
3131 struct minimal_symbol *debug_hook;
3132
3133 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3134 if (debug_hook == NULL)
3135 {
3136 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = &msym_not_found;
3137 continue;
3138 }
3139
3140 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3141 }
3142
3143 addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3144 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3145 &current_target);
3146 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3147 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3148 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
3149 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3150 }
3151
3152 update_global_location_list (1);
3153 }
3154
3155 void
3156 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3157 {
3158 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3159 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3160
3161 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3162 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3163 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3164 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3165 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3166 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3167 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3168 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3169 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3170 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3171 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3172
3173 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3174 {
3175 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3176 continue;
3177
3178 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3179 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3180 {
3181 delete_breakpoint (b);
3182 continue;
3183 }
3184
3185 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3186 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3187 {
3188 delete_breakpoint (b);
3189 continue;
3190 }
3191
3192 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3193 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3194 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3195 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3196 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3197 {
3198 delete_breakpoint (b);
3199 continue;
3200 }
3201
3202 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3203 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3204 {
3205 delete_breakpoint (b);
3206 continue;
3207 }
3208
3209 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3210 after an exec. */
3211 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3212 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3213 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3214 {
3215 delete_breakpoint (b);
3216 continue;
3217 }
3218
3219 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3220 {
3221 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3222 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3223 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3224 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3225 continue;
3226 }
3227
3228 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3229 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3230 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3231 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3232 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3233 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3234
3235 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3236 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3237 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3238 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3239 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3240 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3241 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3242
3243 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3244 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3245 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3246 let finish_command delete it.
3247
3248 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3249 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3250 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3251 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3252 solib breakpoints.) */
3253
3254 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3255 {
3256 continue;
3257 }
3258
3259 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3260 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3261 a.out. */
3262 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
3263 {
3264 delete_breakpoint (b);
3265 continue;
3266 }
3267 }
3268 /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints? Re-create them here? */
3269 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
3270 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
3271 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
3272 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
3273 }
3274
3275 int
3276 detach_breakpoints (int pid)
3277 {
3278 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3279 int val = 0;
3280 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
3281 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3282
3283 if (pid == PIDGET (inferior_ptid))
3284 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3285
3286 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3287 inferior_ptid = pid_to_ptid (pid);
3288 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3289 {
3290 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3291 continue;
3292
3293 if (bl->inserted)
3294 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, mark_inserted);
3295 }
3296
3297 /* Detach single-step breakpoints as well. */
3298 detach_single_step_breakpoints ();
3299
3300 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3301 return val;
3302 }
3303
3304 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3305 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3306 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3307 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3308 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3309
3310 static int
3311 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, insertion_state_t is)
3312 {
3313 int val;
3314
3315 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3316 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3317
3318 if (bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
3319 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
3320 return 0;
3321
3322 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3323 This should not ever happen. */
3324 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3325
3326 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3327 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3328 {
3329 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3330 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3331 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3332
3333 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3334 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3335 || bl->section == NULL
3336 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3337 {
3338 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3339 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
3340 }
3341 else
3342 {
3343 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3344 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3345 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3346 {
3347 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3348 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3349 */
3350 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3351 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3352 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3353 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3354 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3355 else
3356 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3357 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3358 }
3359 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3360 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3361 if (bl->inserted)
3362 {
3363 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3364 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3365 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3366 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3367
3368 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3369 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3370 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3371 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3372 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3373 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
3374 else
3375 val = 0;
3376 }
3377 else
3378 {
3379 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3380 val = 0;
3381 }
3382 }
3383
3384 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint
3385 in a shared library that has already been removed, but we
3386 have not yet processed the shlib unload event. */
3387 if (val && solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address))
3388 val = 0;
3389
3390 if (val)
3391 return val;
3392 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
3393 }
3394 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
3395 {
3396 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3397 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3398
3399 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
3400 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
3401
3402 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
3403 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (bl->inserted))
3404 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
3405 bl->owner->number);
3406 }
3407 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
3408 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3409 && !bl->duplicate)
3410 {
3411 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3412 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3413
3414 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
3415 if (val)
3416 return val;
3417
3418 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
3419 }
3420
3421 return 0;
3422 }
3423
3424 static int
3425 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl, insertion_state_t is)
3426 {
3427 int ret;
3428 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3429
3430 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3431 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3432
3433 if (bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
3434 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
3435 return 0;
3436
3437 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3438 This should not ever happen. */
3439 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3440
3441 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
3442
3443 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3444
3445 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, is);
3446
3447 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3448 return ret;
3449 }
3450
3451 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
3452
3453 void
3454 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
3455 {
3456 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3457
3458 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3459 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
3460 bl->inserted = 0;
3461 }
3462
3463 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
3464 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
3465
3466 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
3467 between runs.
3468
3469 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
3470 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
3471 init_wait_for_inferior). */
3472
3473
3474
3475 void
3476 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
3477 {
3478 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3479 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3480 int ix;
3481 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
3482
3483 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
3484 nothing to do. */
3485 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))
3486 return;
3487
3488 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3489 {
3490 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3491 if (bl->pspace == pspace
3492 && bl->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3493 bl->inserted = 0;
3494 }
3495
3496 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3497 {
3498 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
3499 continue;
3500
3501 switch (b->type)
3502 {
3503 case bp_call_dummy:
3504 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
3505
3506 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
3507 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
3508 rid of it. */
3509
3510 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3511
3512 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
3513
3514 case bp_shlib_event:
3515
3516 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
3517 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
3518 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
3519 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
3520 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
3521
3522 (gdb) file prog-linux
3523 (gdb) run # native linux target
3524 ...
3525 (gdb) kill
3526 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
3527 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
3528 */
3529
3530 case bp_step_resume:
3531
3532 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
3533
3534 delete_breakpoint (b);
3535 break;
3536
3537 case bp_watchpoint:
3538 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3539 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3540 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3541 {
3542 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
3543
3544 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
3545 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
3546 delete_breakpoint (b);
3547 else if (context == inf_starting)
3548 {
3549 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
3550 insert_breakpoints. */
3551 if (w->val)
3552 value_free (w->val);
3553 w->val = NULL;
3554 w->val_valid = 0;
3555 }
3556 }
3557 break;
3558 default:
3559 break;
3560 }
3561 }
3562
3563 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
3564 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bl); ++ix)
3565 decref_bp_location (&bl);
3566 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
3567 }
3568
3569 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
3570 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
3571 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
3572 match, not program space. */
3573
3574 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
3575 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
3576 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
3577 permanent breakpoint.
3578 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
3579 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
3580 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
3581 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
3582 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
3583
3584 enum breakpoint_here
3585 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
3586 {
3587 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3588 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
3589
3590 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3591 {
3592 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3593 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3594 continue;
3595
3596 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3597 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3598 || bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
3599 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
3600 {
3601 if (overlay_debugging
3602 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3603 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3604 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
3605 else if (bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
3606 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
3607 else
3608 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
3609 }
3610 }
3611
3612 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
3613 }
3614
3615 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
3616
3617 int
3618 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
3619 {
3620 struct bp_location *loc;
3621 int ix;
3622
3623 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
3624 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
3625 return 1;
3626
3627 return 0;
3628 }
3629
3630 /* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
3631 inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array
3632 mechanism. This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which
3633 are inserted and removed using direct target manipulation. */
3634
3635 int
3636 regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
3637 CORE_ADDR pc)
3638 {
3639 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3640
3641 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3642 {
3643 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3644 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3645 continue;
3646
3647 if (bl->inserted
3648 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
3649 {
3650 if (overlay_debugging
3651 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3652 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3653 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
3654 else
3655 return 1;
3656 }
3657 }
3658 return 0;
3659 }
3660
3661 /* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
3662 or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC. */
3663
3664 int
3665 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
3666 {
3667 if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
3668 return 1;
3669
3670 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
3671 return 1;
3672
3673 return 0;
3674 }
3675
3676 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
3677 inserted at PC. */
3678
3679 int
3680 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
3681 CORE_ADDR pc)
3682 {
3683 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3684
3685 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3686 {
3687 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
3688 continue;
3689
3690 if (bl->inserted
3691 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
3692 aspace, pc))
3693 {
3694 if (overlay_debugging
3695 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3696 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3697 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
3698 else
3699 return 1;
3700 }
3701 }
3702
3703 /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints. */
3704 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
3705 return 1;
3706
3707 return 0;
3708 }
3709
3710 int
3711 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
3712 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
3713 {
3714 struct breakpoint *bpt;
3715
3716 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
3717 {
3718 struct bp_location *loc;
3719
3720 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
3721 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
3722 continue;
3723
3724 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
3725 continue;
3726
3727 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3728 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
3729 {
3730 CORE_ADDR l, h;
3731
3732 /* Check for intersection. */
3733 l = max (loc->address, addr);
3734 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
3735 if (l < h)
3736 return 1;
3737 }
3738 }
3739 return 0;
3740 }
3741
3742 /* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
3743 PC is valid for process/thread PTID. */
3744
3745 int
3746 breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
3747 ptid_t ptid)
3748 {
3749 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3750 /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily. */
3751 int thread = -1;
3752 int task = 0;
3753
3754 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3755 {
3756 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3757 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3758 continue;
3759
3760 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has bl->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3761 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3762 && bl->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3763 continue;
3764
3765 if (!breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
3766 continue;
3767
3768 if (bl->owner->thread != -1)
3769 {
3770 /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
3771 matches that thread. If thread hasn't been computed yet,
3772 it is now time to do so. */
3773 if (thread == -1)
3774 thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
3775 if (bl->owner->thread != thread)
3776 continue;
3777 }
3778
3779 if (bl->owner->task != 0)
3780 {
3781 /* This is a task-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
3782 matches that task. If task hasn't been computed yet,
3783 it is now time to do so. */
3784 if (task == 0)
3785 task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
3786 if (bl->owner->task != task)
3787 continue;
3788 }
3789
3790 if (overlay_debugging
3791 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3792 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3793 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
3794
3795 return 1;
3796 }
3797
3798 return 0;
3799 }
3800 \f
3801
3802 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
3803 in breakpoint.h. */
3804
3805 int
3806 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
3807 {
3808 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
3809 }
3810
3811 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
3812 'next' chain. */
3813
3814 static void
3815 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
3816 {
3817 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
3818 value_free (bs->old_val);
3819 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
3820 decref_bp_location (&bs->bp_location_at);
3821 xfree (bs);
3822 }
3823
3824 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
3825 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
3826
3827 void
3828 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
3829 {
3830 bpstat p;
3831 bpstat q;
3832
3833 if (bsp == 0)
3834 return;
3835 p = *bsp;
3836 while (p != NULL)
3837 {
3838 q = p->next;
3839 bpstat_free (p);
3840 p = q;
3841 }
3842 *bsp = NULL;
3843 }
3844
3845 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
3846 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
3847
3848 bpstat
3849 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
3850 {
3851 bpstat p = NULL;
3852 bpstat tmp;
3853 bpstat retval = NULL;
3854
3855 if (bs == NULL)
3856 return bs;
3857
3858 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3859 {
3860 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
3861 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
3862 incref_counted_command_line (tmp->commands);
3863 incref_bp_location (tmp->bp_location_at);
3864 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
3865 {
3866 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
3867 release_value (tmp->old_val);
3868 }
3869
3870 if (p == NULL)
3871 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
3872 retval = tmp;
3873 else
3874 p->next = tmp;
3875 p = tmp;
3876 }
3877 p->next = NULL;
3878 return retval;
3879 }
3880
3881 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
3882
3883 bpstat
3884 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
3885 {
3886 if (bsp == NULL)
3887 return NULL;
3888
3889 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
3890 {
3891 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
3892 return bsp;
3893 }
3894 return NULL;
3895 }
3896
3897 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
3898 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
3899 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
3900 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
3901
3902 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
3903 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
3904 we set it.
3905 Return 1 otherwise. */
3906
3907 int
3908 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
3909 {
3910 struct breakpoint *b;
3911
3912 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
3913 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
3914
3915 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
3916 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
3917 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
3918 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
3919 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
3920 if (b == NULL)
3921 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
3922
3923 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
3924 return 1;
3925 }
3926
3927 /* See breakpoint.h. */
3928
3929 void
3930 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
3931 {
3932 struct thread_info *tp;
3933 bpstat bs;
3934
3935 if (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3936 return;
3937
3938 tp = find_thread_ptid (inferior_ptid);
3939 if (tp == NULL)
3940 return;
3941
3942 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3943 {
3944 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
3945
3946 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
3947 {
3948 value_free (bs->old_val);
3949 bs->old_val = NULL;
3950 }
3951 }
3952 }
3953
3954 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
3955
3956 static void
3957 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
3958 {
3959 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3960 {
3961 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
3962
3963 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
3964 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
3965 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
3966 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
3967 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
3968 return;
3969 }
3970
3971 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
3972 }
3973
3974 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint
3975 command. */
3976 static void
3977 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
3978 {
3979 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
3980 }
3981
3982 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
3983 or its equivalent. */
3984
3985 static int
3986 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
3987 {
3988 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0
3989 || (xdb_commands && strcmp ("Q", cmd->line) == 0));
3990 }
3991
3992 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
3993 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
3994 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
3995 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
3996
3997 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
3998 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
3999 bpstat of the current thread. */
4000
4001 static int
4002 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4003 {
4004 bpstat bs;
4005 struct cleanup *old_chain;
4006 int again = 0;
4007
4008 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4009 in bs->commands. */
4010 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4011 return 0;
4012
4013 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
4014 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
4015
4016 prevent_dont_repeat ();
4017
4018 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4019 bs = *bsp;
4020
4021 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4022 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4023 {
4024 struct counted_command_line *ccmd;
4025 struct command_line *cmd;
4026 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
4027
4028 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4029
4030 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4031 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4032 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4033 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4034 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4035 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4036 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4037 the tree when we're done. */
4038 ccmd = bs->commands;
4039 bs->commands = NULL;
4040 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&ccmd);
4041 cmd = ccmd ? ccmd->commands : NULL;
4042 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4043 {
4044 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4045 cmd = cmd->next;
4046 }
4047
4048 while (cmd != NULL)
4049 {
4050 execute_control_command (cmd);
4051
4052 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4053 break;
4054 else
4055 cmd = cmd->next;
4056 }
4057
4058 /* We can free this command tree now. */
4059 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
4060
4061 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4062 {
4063 if (target_can_async_p ())
4064 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4065 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4066 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4067 ;
4068 else
4069 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4070 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4071 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4072 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4073 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4074 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4075 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4076 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4077 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4078 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4079 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4080 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4081 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4082 again = 1;
4083 break;
4084 }
4085 }
4086 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4087 return again;
4088 }
4089
4090 void
4091 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4092 {
4093 struct cleanup *cleanup_if_error = make_bpstat_clear_actions_cleanup ();
4094
4095 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4096 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
4097 && target_has_execution
4098 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
4099 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
4100 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
4101 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
4102 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
4103 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4104 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->control.stop_bpstat))
4105 break;
4106
4107 discard_cleanups (cleanup_if_error);
4108 }
4109
4110 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4111
4112 static void
4113 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4114 {
4115 if (val == NULL)
4116 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
4117 else
4118 {
4119 struct value_print_options opts;
4120 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4121 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4122 }
4123 }
4124
4125 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4126 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4127 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4128 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4129 normal_stop(). */
4130
4131 static enum print_stop_action
4132 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4133 {
4134 switch (bs->print_it)
4135 {
4136 case print_it_noop:
4137 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4138 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4139 break;
4140
4141 case print_it_done:
4142 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4143 relevant messages. */
4144 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4145 break;
4146
4147 case print_it_normal:
4148 {
4149 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4150
4151 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4152 which has since been deleted. */
4153 if (b == NULL)
4154 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4155
4156 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4157 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4158 }
4159 break;
4160
4161 default:
4162 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4163 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4164 break;
4165 }
4166 }
4167
4168 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4169
4170 static void
4171 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4172 {
4173 int any_deleted
4174 = !VEC_empty (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs);
4175 int any_added
4176 = !VEC_empty (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs);
4177
4178 if (!is_catchpoint)
4179 {
4180 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4181 ui_out_text (current_uiout,
4182 _("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4183 else
4184 ui_out_text (current_uiout,
4185 _("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4186 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4187 }
4188
4189 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
4190 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "reason",
4191 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4192
4193 if (any_deleted)
4194 {
4195 struct cleanup *cleanup;
4196 char *name;
4197 int ix;
4198
4199 ui_out_text (current_uiout, _(" Inferior unloaded "));
4200 cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout,
4201 "removed");
4202 for (ix = 0;
4203 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
4204 ix, name);
4205 ++ix)
4206 {
4207 if (ix > 0)
4208 ui_out_text (current_uiout, " ");
4209 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "library", name);
4210 ui_out_text (current_uiout, "\n");
4211 }
4212
4213 do_cleanups (cleanup);
4214 }
4215
4216 if (any_added)
4217 {
4218 struct so_list *iter;
4219 int ix;
4220 struct cleanup *cleanup;
4221
4222 ui_out_text (current_uiout, _(" Inferior loaded "));
4223 cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout,
4224 "added");
4225 for (ix = 0;
4226 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
4227 ix, iter);
4228 ++ix)
4229 {
4230 if (ix > 0)
4231 ui_out_text (current_uiout, " ");
4232 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "library", iter->so_name);
4233 ui_out_text (current_uiout, "\n");
4234 }
4235
4236 do_cleanups (cleanup);
4237 }
4238 }
4239
4240 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4241 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4242 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4243 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4244 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4245 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4246 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4247 routine is one of:
4248
4249 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4250 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4251 code to print the location. An example is
4252 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4253 the location.
4254 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4255 to also print the location part of the message.
4256 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4257 don't require a location appended to the end.
4258 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4259 further info to be printed. */
4260
4261 enum print_stop_action
4262 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4263 {
4264 int val;
4265
4266 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4267 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4268 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4269 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4270 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4271 {
4272 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4273 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4274 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4275 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4276 return val;
4277 }
4278
4279 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4280 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4281 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4282 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4283 {
4284 print_solib_event (0);
4285 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4286 }
4287
4288 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4289 with and nothing was printed. */
4290 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4291 }
4292
4293 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero. This is
4294 used inside a catch_errors to evaluate the breakpoint condition.
4295 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to a
4296 "char *" to make it pass through catch_errors. */
4297
4298 static int
4299 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
4300 {
4301 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4302 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
4303
4304 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4305 return i;
4306 }
4307
4308 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4309
4310 static bpstat
4311 bpstat_alloc (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4312 {
4313 bpstat bs;
4314
4315 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
4316 bs->next = NULL;
4317 **bs_link_pointer = bs;
4318 *bs_link_pointer = &bs->next;
4319 bs->breakpoint_at = bl->owner;
4320 bs->bp_location_at = bl;
4321 incref_bp_location (bl);
4322 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
4323 bs->commands = NULL;
4324 bs->old_val = NULL;
4325 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
4326 return bs;
4327 }
4328 \f
4329 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4330 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4331
4332 int
4333 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4334 {
4335 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4336 CORE_ADDR addr;
4337 struct breakpoint *b;
4338
4339 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4340 {
4341 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4342 as not triggered. */
4343 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4344 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4345 {
4346 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4347
4348 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4349 }
4350
4351 return 0;
4352 }
4353
4354 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
4355 {
4356 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4357 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4358 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4359 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4360 {
4361 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4362
4363 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4364 }
4365
4366 return stopped_by_watchpoint;
4367 }
4368
4369 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4370 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4371 triggered. */
4372
4373 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4374 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4375 {
4376 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4377 struct bp_location *loc;
4378
4379 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4380 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4381 {
4382 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4383 {
4384 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4385 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4386
4387 if (newaddr == start)
4388 {
4389 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4390 break;
4391 }
4392 }
4393 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4394 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
4395 addr, loc->address,
4396 loc->length))
4397 {
4398 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4399 break;
4400 }
4401 }
4402 }
4403
4404 return 1;
4405 }
4406
4407 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
4408 because of check_errors). */
4409 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4410 #define WP_DELETED 1
4411 /* The value has changed. */
4412 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
4413 /* The value has not changed. */
4414 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
4415 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4416 #define WP_IGNORE 4
4417
4418 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4419 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4420
4421 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4422 changed.
4423
4424 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
4425 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
4426
4427 static int
4428 watchpoint_check (void *p)
4429 {
4430 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
4431 struct watchpoint *b;
4432 struct frame_info *fr;
4433 int within_current_scope;
4434
4435 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4436 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
4437 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4438
4439 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4440 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4441 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4442 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
4443 return WP_IGNORE;
4444
4445 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
4446 within_current_scope = 1;
4447 else
4448 {
4449 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
4450 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4451 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
4452
4453 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
4454 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
4455 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
4456 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
4457 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
4458 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
4459 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
4460 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
4461 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
4462 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
4463 return WP_IGNORE;
4464
4465 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
4466 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
4467
4468 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
4469 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
4470 if (within_current_scope)
4471 {
4472 struct symbol *function;
4473
4474 function = get_frame_function (fr);
4475 if (function == NULL
4476 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
4477 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
4478 within_current_scope = 0;
4479 }
4480
4481 if (within_current_scope)
4482 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
4483 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
4484 the user. */
4485 select_frame (fr);
4486 }
4487
4488 if (within_current_scope)
4489 {
4490 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
4491 time before we return to the command level and call
4492 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
4493 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
4494
4495 int pc = 0;
4496 struct value *mark;
4497 struct value *new_val;
4498
4499 if (is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base))
4500 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
4501 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
4502 a mask watchpoint. */
4503 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4504
4505 mark = value_mark ();
4506 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL);
4507
4508 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
4509 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
4510 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
4511 not what we want. */
4512 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
4513 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
4514 {
4515 if (new_val != NULL)
4516 {
4517 release_value (new_val);
4518 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4519 }
4520 bs->old_val = b->val;
4521 b->val = new_val;
4522 b->val_valid = 1;
4523 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4524 }
4525 else
4526 {
4527 /* Nothing changed. */
4528 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4529 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
4530 }
4531 }
4532 else
4533 {
4534 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
4535
4536 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
4537 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
4538 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
4539 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
4540 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
4541 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
4542 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
4543 the first value assigned). */
4544 /* We print all the stop information in
4545 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
4546 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
4547 already. So we have no choice but print the information
4548 here. */
4549 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4550 ui_out_field_string
4551 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
4552 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
4553 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->base.number);
4554 ui_out_text (uiout,
4555 " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
4556 which its expression is valid.\n");
4557
4558 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
4559 decref_counted_command_line (&b->base.commands);
4560 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
4561
4562 return WP_DELETED;
4563 }
4564 }
4565
4566 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
4567 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
4568 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
4569
4570 static int
4571 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
4572 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
4573 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4574 {
4575 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
4576
4577 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
4578 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
4579
4580 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
4581 }
4582
4583 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
4584 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
4585
4586 static void
4587 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
4588 {
4589 const struct bp_location *bl;
4590 struct watchpoint *b;
4591
4592 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
4593 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
4594 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
4595 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4596 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
4597
4598 {
4599 int must_check_value = 0;
4600
4601 if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint)
4602 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
4603 watched value. */
4604 must_check_value = 1;
4605 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
4606 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
4607 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
4608 this watchpoint. */
4609 must_check_value = 1;
4610 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
4611 && b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
4612 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
4613 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
4614 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
4615 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
4616 must_check_value = 1;
4617
4618 if (must_check_value)
4619 {
4620 char *message
4621 = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
4622 b->base.number);
4623 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
4624 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
4625 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
4626 do_cleanups (cleanups);
4627 switch (e)
4628 {
4629 case WP_DELETED:
4630 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
4631 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
4632 /* Stop. */
4633 break;
4634 case WP_IGNORE:
4635 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
4636 bs->stop = 0;
4637 break;
4638 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
4639 if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint)
4640 {
4641 /* There are two cases to consider here:
4642
4643 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
4644 In that case, trust the target, and always report
4645 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
4646 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
4647 have changed since the last time it was read, and
4648 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
4649 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
4650 old value.
4651
4652 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
4653 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
4654 happen:
4655
4656 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
4657 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
4658 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
4659 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
4660
4661 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
4662 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
4663 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
4664 watchpoint.
4665
4666 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
4667 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
4668 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
4669 changes. This still gives false positives when
4670 the program writes the same value to memory as
4671 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
4672 it for a read), but it's much better than
4673 nothing. */
4674
4675 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
4676
4677 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
4678 {
4679 struct breakpoint *other_b;
4680
4681 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
4682 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
4683 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
4684 {
4685 struct watchpoint *other_w =
4686 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
4687
4688 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
4689 == watch_triggered_yes)
4690 {
4691 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
4692 break;
4693 }
4694 }
4695 }
4696
4697 if (other_write_watchpoint
4698 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
4699 {
4700 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
4701 and the value changed since the last time we
4702 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
4703 Ignore it. */
4704 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
4705 bs->stop = 0;
4706 }
4707 }
4708 break;
4709 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
4710 if (b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
4711 || b->base.type == bp_watchpoint)
4712 {
4713 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
4714 the value hasn't changed. */
4715 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
4716 bs->stop = 0;
4717 }
4718 /* Stop. */
4719 break;
4720 default:
4721 /* Can't happen. */
4722 case 0:
4723 /* Error from catch_errors. */
4724 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->base.number);
4725 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
4726 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
4727 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
4728 break;
4729 }
4730 }
4731 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
4732 {
4733 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
4734 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
4735 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
4736 anything for this watchpoint. */
4737 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
4738 bs->stop = 0;
4739 }
4740 }
4741 }
4742
4743
4744 /* Check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
4745 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
4746 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
4747
4748 static void
4749 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
4750 {
4751 int thread_id = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
4752 const struct bp_location *bl;
4753 struct breakpoint *b;
4754
4755 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
4756 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
4757 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
4758 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4759 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
4760
4761 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
4762 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
4763 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
4764
4765 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
4766 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
4767 bs->stop = 0;
4768 else if (bs->stop)
4769 {
4770 int value_is_zero = 0;
4771 struct expression *cond;
4772
4773 /* Evaluate Python breakpoints that have a "stop"
4774 method implemented. */
4775 if (b->py_bp_object)
4776 bs->stop = gdbpy_should_stop (b->py_bp_object);
4777
4778 if (is_watchpoint (b))
4779 {
4780 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4781
4782 cond = w->cond_exp;
4783 }
4784 else
4785 cond = bl->cond;
4786
4787 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
4788 {
4789 int within_current_scope = 1;
4790 struct watchpoint * w;
4791
4792 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
4793 be a long time before we return to the command level and
4794 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
4795 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
4796 function call. */
4797 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4798
4799 if (is_watchpoint (b))
4800 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4801 else
4802 w = NULL;
4803
4804 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
4805 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
4806 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
4807 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
4808 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
4809 call site. */
4810 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
4811 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
4812 else
4813 {
4814 struct frame_info *frame;
4815
4816 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
4817 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
4818 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
4819 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
4820 really matter which instantiation of the function
4821 where the condition makes sense triggers the
4822 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
4823 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
4824 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
4825 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
4826 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
4827 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
4828 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
4829 intuitive. */
4830 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
4831 if (frame != NULL)
4832 select_frame (frame);
4833 else
4834 within_current_scope = 0;
4835 }
4836 if (within_current_scope)
4837 value_is_zero
4838 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, cond,
4839 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
4840 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
4841 else
4842 {
4843 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
4844 "in the current scope"));
4845 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
4846 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
4847 value_is_zero = 0;
4848 }
4849 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
4850 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4851 }
4852
4853 if (cond && value_is_zero)
4854 {
4855 bs->stop = 0;
4856 }
4857 else if (b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread_id)
4858 {
4859 bs->stop = 0;
4860 }
4861 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
4862 {
4863 b->ignore_count--;
4864 annotate_ignore_count_change ();
4865 bs->stop = 0;
4866 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
4867 ++(b->hit_count);
4868 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
4869 }
4870 }
4871 }
4872
4873
4874 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
4875 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
4876
4877 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
4878 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such
4879 that:
4880
4881 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
4882
4883 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
4884
4885 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
4886 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
4887 several reasons concurrently.)
4888
4889 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
4890 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
4891
4892 bpstat
4893 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
4894 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid,
4895 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4896 {
4897 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
4898 struct bp_location *bl;
4899 struct bp_location *loc;
4900 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
4901 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
4902 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
4903 bpstat bs;
4904 int ix;
4905 int need_remove_insert;
4906 int removed_any;
4907
4908 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
4909 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
4910 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
4911 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
4912 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
4913 inferior function calls. */
4914
4915 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4916 {
4917 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
4918 continue;
4919
4920 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
4921 {
4922 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
4923 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
4924 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
4925 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
4926 checked all locations already. */
4927 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
4928 break;
4929
4930 if (bl->shlib_disabled)
4931 continue;
4932
4933 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
4934 continue;
4935
4936 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
4937 matches. */
4938
4939 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
4940 explain stop. */
4941
4942 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
4943 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
4944 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
4945 bs->stop = 1;
4946 bs->print = 1;
4947
4948 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
4949 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
4950 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
4951 iteration. */
4952 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
4953 {
4954 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
4955
4956 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4957 }
4958 }
4959 }
4960
4961 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
4962 {
4963 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr))
4964 {
4965 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, &bs_link);
4966 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
4967 bs->stop = 0;
4968 bs->print = 0;
4969 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
4970 }
4971 }
4972
4973 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
4974 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
4975 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
4976 "catch unload". */
4977 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4978 {
4979 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
4980 {
4981 handle_solib_event ();
4982 break;
4983 }
4984 }
4985
4986 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
4987 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
4988 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
4989
4990 removed_any = 0;
4991
4992 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4993 {
4994 if (!bs->stop)
4995 continue;
4996
4997 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4998 b->ops->check_status (bs);
4999 if (bs->stop)
5000 {
5001 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
5002
5003 if (bs->stop)
5004 {
5005 ++(b->hit_count);
5006 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5007
5008 /* We will stop here. */
5009 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5010 {
5011 --(b->enable_count);
5012 if (b->enable_count <= 0
5013 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
5014 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5015 removed_any = 1;
5016 }
5017 if (b->silent)
5018 bs->print = 0;
5019 bs->commands = b->commands;
5020 incref_counted_command_line (bs->commands);
5021 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5022 ? bs->commands->commands : NULL))
5023 bs->print = 0;
5024 }
5025
5026 }
5027
5028 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5029 print. */
5030 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5031 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5032 }
5033
5034 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5035 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5036 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5037 done later. */
5038 need_remove_insert = 0;
5039 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5040 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5041 if (!bs->stop
5042 && bs->breakpoint_at
5043 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5044 {
5045 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5046
5047 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5048 need_remove_insert = 1;
5049 }
5050
5051 if (need_remove_insert)
5052 update_global_location_list (1);
5053 else if (removed_any)
5054 update_global_location_list (0);
5055
5056 return bs_head;
5057 }
5058
5059 static void
5060 handle_jit_event (void)
5061 {
5062 struct frame_info *frame;
5063 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5064
5065 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5066 breakpoint_re_set. */
5067 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5068
5069 frame = get_current_frame ();
5070 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5071
5072 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5073
5074 target_terminal_inferior ();
5075 }
5076
5077 /* Handle an solib event by calling solib_add. */
5078
5079 void
5080 handle_solib_event (void)
5081 {
5082 clear_program_space_solib_cache (current_inferior ()->pspace);
5083
5084 /* Check for any newly added shared libraries if we're supposed to
5085 be adding them automatically. Switch terminal for any messages
5086 produced by breakpoint_re_set. */
5087 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5088 #ifdef SOLIB_ADD
5089 SOLIB_ADD (NULL, 0, &current_target, auto_solib_add);
5090 #else
5091 solib_add (NULL, 0, &current_target, auto_solib_add);
5092 #endif
5093 target_terminal_inferior ();
5094 }
5095
5096 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5097
5098 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5099
5100 struct bpstat_what
5101 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5102 {
5103 struct bpstat_what retval;
5104 int jit_event = 0;
5105 bpstat bs;
5106
5107 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5108 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5109 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
5110
5111 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5112 {
5113 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5114 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5115 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5116 enum bptype bptype;
5117
5118 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5119 {
5120 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5121 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5122 bptype = bp_none;
5123 }
5124 else
5125 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5126
5127 switch (bptype)
5128 {
5129 case bp_none:
5130 break;
5131 case bp_breakpoint:
5132 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5133 case bp_until:
5134 case bp_finish:
5135 case bp_shlib_event:
5136 if (bs->stop)
5137 {
5138 if (bs->print)
5139 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5140 else
5141 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5142 }
5143 else
5144 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5145 break;
5146 case bp_watchpoint:
5147 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5148 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5149 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5150 if (bs->stop)
5151 {
5152 if (bs->print)
5153 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5154 else
5155 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5156 }
5157 else
5158 {
5159 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5160 This requires no further action. */
5161 }
5162 break;
5163 case bp_longjmp:
5164 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5165 case bp_exception:
5166 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5167 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5168 break;
5169 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5170 case bp_exception_resume:
5171 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5172 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5173 break;
5174 case bp_step_resume:
5175 if (bs->stop)
5176 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5177 else
5178 {
5179 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5180 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5181 }
5182 break;
5183 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5184 if (bs->stop)
5185 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5186 else
5187 {
5188 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5189 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5190 }
5191 break;
5192 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5193 case bp_thread_event:
5194 case bp_overlay_event:
5195 case bp_longjmp_master:
5196 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5197 case bp_exception_master:
5198 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5199 break;
5200 case bp_catchpoint:
5201 if (bs->stop)
5202 {
5203 if (bs->print)
5204 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5205 else
5206 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5207 }
5208 else
5209 {
5210 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5211 This requires no further action. */
5212 }
5213 break;
5214 case bp_jit_event:
5215 jit_event = 1;
5216 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5217 break;
5218 case bp_call_dummy:
5219 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5220 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5221 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5222 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5223 break;
5224 case bp_std_terminate:
5225 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5226 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5227 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5228 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5229 break;
5230 case bp_tracepoint:
5231 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5232 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5233 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5234 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5235 out already. */
5236 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5237 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5238 break;
5239 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5240 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5241 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5242 break;
5243 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5244 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5245 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5246 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5247 break;
5248
5249 case bp_dprintf:
5250 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5251 break;
5252
5253 default:
5254 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5255 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5256 }
5257
5258 retval.main_action = max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5259 }
5260
5261 /* These operations may affect the bs->breakpoint_at state so they are
5262 delayed after MAIN_ACTION is decided above. */
5263
5264 if (jit_event)
5265 {
5266 if (debug_infrun)
5267 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "bpstat_what: bp_jit_event\n");
5268
5269 handle_jit_event ();
5270 }
5271
5272 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5273 {
5274 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5275
5276 if (b == NULL)
5277 continue;
5278 switch (b->type)
5279 {
5280 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5281 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5282 break;
5283 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5284 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5285 break;
5286 }
5287 }
5288
5289 return retval;
5290 }
5291
5292 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
5293 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
5294 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
5295
5296 int
5297 bpstat_should_step (void)
5298 {
5299 struct breakpoint *b;
5300
5301 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5302 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5303 return 1;
5304 return 0;
5305 }
5306
5307 int
5308 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5309 {
5310 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5311 if (bs->stop)
5312 return 1;
5313
5314 return 0;
5315 }
5316
5317 \f
5318
5319 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5320 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5321 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5322
5323 static char *
5324 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5325 {
5326 static char wrap_indent[80];
5327 int i, total_width, width, align;
5328 char *text;
5329
5330 total_width = 0;
5331 for (i = 1; ui_out_query_field (uiout, i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5332 {
5333 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5334 {
5335 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5336 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5337 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5338
5339 return wrap_indent;
5340 }
5341
5342 total_width += width + 1;
5343 }
5344
5345 return NULL;
5346 }
5347
5348 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5349 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5350
5351 "host": Host evals condition.
5352 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5353 "target": Target evals condition.
5354 */
5355
5356 static const char *
5357 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5358 {
5359 struct bp_location *bl;
5360 char host_evals = 0;
5361 char target_evals = 0;
5362
5363 if (!b)
5364 return NULL;
5365
5366 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5367 return NULL;
5368
5369 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5370 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5371 return condition_evaluation_host;
5372
5373 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5374 {
5375 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
5376 target_evals++;
5377 else
5378 host_evals++;
5379 }
5380
5381 if (host_evals && target_evals)
5382 return condition_evaluation_both;
5383 else if (target_evals)
5384 return condition_evaluation_target;
5385 else
5386 return condition_evaluation_host;
5387 }
5388
5389 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5390 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5391
5392 static const char *
5393 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
5394 {
5395 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
5396 return NULL;
5397
5398 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5399 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5400 return condition_evaluation_host;
5401
5402 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
5403 return condition_evaluation_target;
5404 else
5405 return condition_evaluation_host;
5406 }
5407
5408 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5409
5410 static void
5411 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5412 struct bp_location *loc)
5413 {
5414 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5415 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
5416
5417 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
5418 loc = NULL;
5419
5420 if (loc != NULL)
5421 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
5422
5423 if (b->display_canonical)
5424 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->addr_string);
5425 else if (loc && loc->source_file)
5426 {
5427 struct symbol *sym
5428 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
5429 if (sym)
5430 {
5431 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
5432 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
5433 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
5434 ui_out_text (uiout, " ");
5435 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
5436 ui_out_text (uiout, "at ");
5437 }
5438 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", loc->source_file);
5439 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
5440
5441 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
5442 {
5443 struct symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (loc->address, 0);
5444 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
5445
5446 if (fullname)
5447 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
5448 }
5449
5450 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", loc->line_number);
5451 }
5452 else if (loc)
5453 {
5454 struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen ();
5455 struct cleanup *stb_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
5456
5457 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb,
5458 demangle, "");
5459 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
5460
5461 do_cleanups (stb_chain);
5462 }
5463 else
5464 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
5465
5466 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
5467 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
5468 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
5469 {
5470 ui_out_text (uiout, " (");
5471 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "evaluated-by",
5472 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
5473 ui_out_text (uiout, ")");
5474 }
5475
5476 do_cleanups (old_chain);
5477 }
5478
5479 static const char *
5480 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
5481 {
5482 struct ep_type_description
5483 {
5484 enum bptype type;
5485 char *description;
5486 };
5487 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
5488 {
5489 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
5490 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
5491 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
5492 {bp_until, "until"},
5493 {bp_finish, "finish"},
5494 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
5495 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
5496 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
5497 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
5498 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
5499 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
5500 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
5501 {bp_exception, "exception"},
5502 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
5503 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
5504 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
5505 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
5506 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
5507 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
5508 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
5509 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
5510 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
5511 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
5512 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
5513 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
5514 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
5515 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
5516 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
5517 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
5518 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
5519 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
5520 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
5521 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
5522 };
5523
5524 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
5525 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
5526 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5527 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
5528 (int) type);
5529
5530 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
5531 }
5532
5533 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
5534
5535 static void
5536 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5537 struct bp_location *loc,
5538 int loc_number,
5539 struct bp_location **last_loc,
5540 int allflag)
5541 {
5542 struct command_line *l;
5543 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
5544
5545 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5546 int header_of_multiple = 0;
5547 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
5548 struct value_print_options opts;
5549
5550 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5551
5552 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
5553 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
5554 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
5555 if (loc == NULL
5556 && (b->loc != NULL
5557 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
5558 header_of_multiple = 1;
5559 if (loc == NULL)
5560 loc = b->loc;
5561
5562 annotate_record ();
5563
5564 /* 1 */
5565 annotate_field (0);
5566 if (part_of_multiple)
5567 {
5568 char *formatted;
5569 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
5570 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
5571 xfree (formatted);
5572 }
5573 else
5574 {
5575 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
5576 }
5577
5578 /* 2 */
5579 annotate_field (1);
5580 if (part_of_multiple)
5581 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
5582 else
5583 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptype_string (b->type));
5584
5585 /* 3 */
5586 annotate_field (2);
5587 if (part_of_multiple)
5588 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
5589 else
5590 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
5591
5592
5593 /* 4 */
5594 annotate_field (3);
5595 if (part_of_multiple)
5596 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
5597 else
5598 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
5599 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
5600 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
5601
5602
5603 /* 5 and 6 */
5604 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
5605 {
5606 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
5607 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
5608 make sure there's just one location. */
5609 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
5610 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
5611 }
5612 else
5613 switch (b->type)
5614 {
5615 case bp_none:
5616 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5617 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
5618 break;
5619
5620 case bp_watchpoint:
5621 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5622 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5623 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5624 {
5625 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5626
5627 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5628 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5629 is relatively readable). */
5630 if (opts.addressprint)
5631 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5632 annotate_field (5);
5633 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", w->exp_string);
5634 }
5635 break;
5636
5637 case bp_breakpoint:
5638 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5639 case bp_until:
5640 case bp_finish:
5641 case bp_longjmp:
5642 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5643 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5644 case bp_exception:
5645 case bp_exception_resume:
5646 case bp_step_resume:
5647 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5648 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5649 case bp_call_dummy:
5650 case bp_std_terminate:
5651 case bp_shlib_event:
5652 case bp_thread_event:
5653 case bp_overlay_event:
5654 case bp_longjmp_master:
5655 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5656 case bp_exception_master:
5657 case bp_tracepoint:
5658 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5659 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5660 case bp_dprintf:
5661 case bp_jit_event:
5662 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5663 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5664 if (opts.addressprint)
5665 {
5666 annotate_field (4);
5667 if (header_of_multiple)
5668 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
5669 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
5670 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
5671 else
5672 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
5673 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
5674 }
5675 annotate_field (5);
5676 if (!header_of_multiple)
5677 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
5678 if (b->loc)
5679 *last_loc = b->loc;
5680 break;
5681 }
5682
5683
5684 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors unless there
5685 are several. */
5686 if (loc != NULL
5687 && !header_of_multiple
5688 && (allflag
5689 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
5690 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
5691 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
5692 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
5693 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
5694 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)))
5695 {
5696 struct inferior *inf;
5697 int first = 1;
5698
5699 for (inf = inferior_list; inf != NULL; inf = inf->next)
5700 {
5701 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
5702 {
5703 if (first)
5704 {
5705 first = 0;
5706 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
5707 }
5708 else
5709 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
5710 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf->num));
5711 }
5712 }
5713 }
5714
5715 if (!part_of_multiple)
5716 {
5717 if (b->thread != -1)
5718 {
5719 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
5720 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
5721 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
5722 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
5723 }
5724 else if (b->task != 0)
5725 {
5726 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
5727 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
5728 }
5729 }
5730
5731 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
5732
5733 if (!part_of_multiple)
5734 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
5735
5736 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
5737 {
5738 annotate_field (6);
5739 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
5740 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
5741 the frame ID. */
5742 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
5743 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
5744 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
5745 }
5746
5747 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
5748 {
5749 annotate_field (7);
5750 if (is_tracepoint (b))
5751 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
5752 else
5753 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
5754 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
5755
5756 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
5757 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
5758 if (is_breakpoint (b)
5759 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
5760 == condition_evaluation_target)
5761 {
5762 ui_out_text (uiout, " (");
5763 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "evaluated-by",
5764 bp_condition_evaluator (b));
5765 ui_out_text (uiout, " evals)");
5766 }
5767 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
5768 }
5769
5770 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
5771 {
5772 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
5773 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
5774 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
5775 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
5776 }
5777
5778 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count)
5779 {
5780 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
5781 if (is_catchpoint (b))
5782 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
5783 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
5784 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttracepoint");
5785 else
5786 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
5787 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
5788 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
5789 if (b->hit_count == 1)
5790 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
5791 else
5792 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
5793 }
5794
5795 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi.
5796 FIXME: Should have a better test for this. */
5797 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
5798 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count == 0)
5799 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
5800
5801 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
5802 {
5803 annotate_field (8);
5804 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
5805 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
5806 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
5807 }
5808
5809 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
5810 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
5811 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
5812 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
5813 {
5814 annotate_field (8);
5815 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tdisable after ");
5816 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
5817 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
5818 if (b->ignore_count)
5819 ui_out_text (uiout, "additional ");
5820 else
5821 ui_out_text (uiout, "next ");
5822 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "enable", b->enable_count);
5823 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
5824 }
5825
5826 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
5827 {
5828 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
5829
5830 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
5831 {
5832 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace buffer usage ");
5833 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
5834 ui_out_text (uiout, " bytes\n");
5835 }
5836 }
5837
5838 l = b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
5839 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
5840 {
5841 struct cleanup *script_chain;
5842
5843 annotate_field (9);
5844 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
5845 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
5846 do_cleanups (script_chain);
5847 }
5848
5849 if (is_tracepoint (b))
5850 {
5851 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
5852
5853 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
5854 {
5855 annotate_field (10);
5856 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
5857 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", t->pass_count);
5858 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
5859 }
5860 }
5861
5862 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
5863 {
5864 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5865 {
5866 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5867
5868 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", w->exp_string);
5869 }
5870 else if (b->addr_string)
5871 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
5872 }
5873 }
5874
5875 static void
5876 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
5877 struct bp_location **last_loc,
5878 int allflag)
5879 {
5880 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
5881 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5882
5883 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
5884
5885 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
5886 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
5887
5888 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
5889 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
5890 locations, if any. */
5891 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
5892 {
5893 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
5894 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
5895 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
5896 situation.
5897
5898 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
5899 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
5900 if (b->loc
5901 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
5902 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))
5903 {
5904 struct bp_location *loc;
5905 int n = 1;
5906
5907 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
5908 {
5909 struct cleanup *inner2 =
5910 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, NULL);
5911 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
5912 do_cleanups (inner2);
5913 }
5914 }
5915 }
5916 }
5917
5918 static int
5919 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
5920 {
5921 int print_address_bits = 0;
5922 struct bp_location *loc;
5923
5924 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
5925 {
5926 int addr_bit;
5927
5928 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have
5929 an address to print. */
5930 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && loc->watchpoint_type == -1)
5931 continue;
5932
5933 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
5934 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
5935 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
5936 }
5937
5938 return print_address_bits;
5939 }
5940
5941 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
5942 {
5943 int bnum;
5944 };
5945
5946 static int
5947 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
5948 {
5949 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
5950 struct breakpoint *b;
5951 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
5952
5953 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5954 {
5955 if (args->bnum == b->number)
5956 {
5957 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
5958 return GDB_RC_OK;
5959 }
5960 }
5961 return GDB_RC_NONE;
5962 }
5963
5964 enum gdb_rc
5965 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum,
5966 char **error_message)
5967 {
5968 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
5969
5970 args.bnum = bnum;
5971 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
5972 an error. */
5973 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
5974 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
5975 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
5976 else
5977 return GDB_RC_OK;
5978 }
5979
5980 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
5981 internal or momentary. */
5982
5983 int
5984 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
5985 {
5986 return b->number > 0;
5987 }
5988
5989 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
5990 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
5991 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
5992 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
5993 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
5994 breakpoints listed. */
5995
5996 static int
5997 breakpoint_1 (char *args, int allflag,
5998 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
5999 {
6000 struct breakpoint *b;
6001 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6002 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6003 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
6004 struct value_print_options opts;
6005 int print_address_bits = 0;
6006 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6007 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6008
6009 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6010
6011 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6012 required for address fields. */
6013 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6014 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6015 {
6016 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6017 if (filter && !filter (b))
6018 continue;
6019
6020 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6021 accept. Skip the others. */
6022 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6023 {
6024 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6025 continue;
6026 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6027 continue;
6028 }
6029
6030 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6031 {
6032 int addr_bit, type_len;
6033
6034 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6035 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6036 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6037
6038 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6039 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6040 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6041
6042 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6043 }
6044 }
6045
6046 if (opts.addressprint)
6047 bkpttbl_chain
6048 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6,
6049 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6050 "BreakpointTable");
6051 else
6052 bkpttbl_chain
6053 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5,
6054 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6055 "BreakpointTable");
6056
6057 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6058 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6059 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6060 annotate_field (0);
6061 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6062 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6063 annotate_field (1);
6064 ui_out_table_header (uiout, print_type_col_width, ui_left,
6065 "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6066 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6067 annotate_field (2);
6068 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6069 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6070 annotate_field (3);
6071 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6072 if (opts.addressprint)
6073 {
6074 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6075 annotate_field (4);
6076 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6077 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left,
6078 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6079 else
6080 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left,
6081 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6082 }
6083 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6084 annotate_field (5);
6085 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6086 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
6087 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6088 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6089
6090 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6091 {
6092 QUIT;
6093 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6094 if (filter && !filter (b))
6095 continue;
6096
6097 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6098 accept. Skip the others. */
6099
6100 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6101 {
6102 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6103 {
6104 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6105 continue;
6106 }
6107 else /* all others */
6108 {
6109 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6110 continue;
6111 }
6112 }
6113 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6114 allflag is set. */
6115 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6116 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
6117 }
6118
6119 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
6120
6121 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6122 {
6123 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6124 empty list. */
6125 if (!filter)
6126 {
6127 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6128 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6129 else
6130 ui_out_message (uiout, 0,
6131 "No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6132 args);
6133 }
6134 }
6135 else
6136 {
6137 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6138 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6139 }
6140
6141 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6142 there have been breakpoints? */
6143 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6144
6145 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6146 }
6147
6148 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6149 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6150
6151 static void
6152 default_collect_info (void)
6153 {
6154 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6155
6156 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6157 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6158 not wanted. */
6159 if (!*default_collect)
6160 return;
6161
6162 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6163 actions. */
6164 ui_out_text (uiout, "default collect ");
6165 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "default-collect", default_collect);
6166 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
6167 }
6168
6169 static void
6170 breakpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
6171 {
6172 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
6173
6174 default_collect_info ();
6175 }
6176
6177 static void
6178 watchpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
6179 {
6180 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
6181 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6182
6183 if (num_printed == 0)
6184 {
6185 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6186 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoints.\n");
6187 else
6188 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6189 }
6190 }
6191
6192 static void
6193 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *args, int from_tty)
6194 {
6195 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
6196
6197 default_collect_info ();
6198 }
6199
6200 static int
6201 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6202 struct program_space *pspace,
6203 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6204 {
6205 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
6206
6207 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
6208 {
6209 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6210 && bl->address == pc
6211 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6212 return 1;
6213 }
6214 return 0;
6215 }
6216
6217 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6218 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6219 address spaces. */
6220
6221 static void
6222 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6223 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6224 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6225 {
6226 int others = 0;
6227 struct breakpoint *b;
6228
6229 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6230 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6231 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6232 if (others > 0)
6233 {
6234 if (others == 1)
6235 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6236 else /* if (others == ???) */
6237 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6238 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6239 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6240 {
6241 others--;
6242 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6243 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6244 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6245 else if (b->thread != -1)
6246 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6247 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6248 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6249 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6250 ? " (disabled)"
6251 : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
6252 ? " (permanent)"
6253 : ""),
6254 (others > 1) ? ","
6255 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6256 }
6257 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
6258 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
6259 printf_filtered (".\n");
6260 }
6261 }
6262 \f
6263
6264 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
6265 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
6266 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
6267 (or use it for any other purpose either).
6268
6269 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
6270 always have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark
6271 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
6272 breakpoint at address zero:
6273
6274 bp_watchpoint
6275 bp_catchpoint
6276
6277 */
6278
6279 static int
6280 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
6281 {
6282 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
6283
6284 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
6285 }
6286
6287 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6288 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6289
6290 static int
6291 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6292 struct bp_location *loc2)
6293 {
6294 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6295 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6296
6297 /* Both of them must exist. */
6298 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
6299 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
6300
6301 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6302 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6303 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6304 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6305 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6306 other watchpoint. */
6307 if ((w1->cond_exp
6308 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
6309 loc1->length,
6310 loc1->watchpoint_type,
6311 w1->cond_exp))
6312 || (w2->cond_exp
6313 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
6314 loc2->length,
6315 loc2->watchpoint_type,
6316 w2->cond_exp)))
6317 return 0;
6318
6319 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6320 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6321 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6322 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6323 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6324 become hw_access locations later. */
6325 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
6326 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
6327 && loc1->address == loc2->address
6328 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6329 }
6330
6331 /* Returns true if {ASPACE1,ADDR1} and {ASPACE2,ADDR2} represent the
6332 same breakpoint location. In most targets, this can only be true
6333 if ASPACE1 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global
6334 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6335
6336 static int
6337 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6338 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
6339 {
6340 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
6341 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6342 && addr1 == addr2);
6343 }
6344
6345 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6346 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6347 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6348 space doesn't really matter. */
6349
6350 static int
6351 breakpoint_address_match_range (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6352 int len1, struct address_space *aspace2,
6353 CORE_ADDR addr2)
6354 {
6355 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
6356 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6357 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
6358 }
6359
6360 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6361 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6362 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6363 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6364
6365 static int
6366 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
6367 struct address_space *aspace,
6368 CORE_ADDR addr)
6369 {
6370 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
6371 aspace, addr)
6372 || (bl->length
6373 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
6374 bl->address, bl->length,
6375 aspace, addr)));
6376 }
6377
6378 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6379 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6380 true, otherwise returns false. */
6381
6382 static int
6383 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6384 struct bp_location *loc2)
6385 {
6386 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6387 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6388 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6389 different locations. */
6390 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
6391 else
6392 return 0;
6393 }
6394
6395 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6396 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
6397 represent the same location. */
6398
6399 static int
6400 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6401 struct bp_location *loc2)
6402 {
6403 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
6404
6405 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
6406 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
6407 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
6408
6409 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
6410 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
6411
6412 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
6413 return 0;
6414 else if (hw_point1)
6415 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6416 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6417 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6418 else
6419 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
6420 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
6421 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
6422 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6423 }
6424
6425 static void
6426 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
6427 int bnum, int have_bnum)
6428 {
6429 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
6430 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
6431 char astr1[64];
6432 char astr2[64];
6433
6434 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
6435 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
6436 if (have_bnum)
6437 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
6438 bnum, astr1, astr2);
6439 else
6440 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
6441 }
6442
6443 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
6444 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
6445 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
6446 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
6447
6448 static CORE_ADDR
6449 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6450 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
6451 {
6452 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
6453 {
6454 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
6455 return bpaddr;
6456 }
6457 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
6458 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
6459 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
6460 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
6461 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
6462 {
6463 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
6464 have their addresses modified. */
6465 return bpaddr;
6466 }
6467 else
6468 {
6469 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
6470
6471 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
6472 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
6473 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
6474
6475 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
6476 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
6477 is required. */
6478 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
6479 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
6480
6481 return adjusted_bpaddr;
6482 }
6483 }
6484
6485 void
6486 init_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc, const struct bp_location_ops *ops,
6487 struct breakpoint *owner)
6488 {
6489 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
6490
6491 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
6492
6493 loc->ops = ops;
6494 loc->owner = owner;
6495 loc->cond = NULL;
6496 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
6497 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
6498 loc->enabled = 1;
6499
6500 switch (owner->type)
6501 {
6502 case bp_breakpoint:
6503 case bp_until:
6504 case bp_finish:
6505 case bp_longjmp:
6506 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6507 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6508 case bp_exception:
6509 case bp_exception_resume:
6510 case bp_step_resume:
6511 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6512 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6513 case bp_call_dummy:
6514 case bp_std_terminate:
6515 case bp_shlib_event:
6516 case bp_thread_event:
6517 case bp_overlay_event:
6518 case bp_jit_event:
6519 case bp_longjmp_master:
6520 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6521 case bp_exception_master:
6522 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6523 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6524 case bp_dprintf:
6525 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
6526 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
6527 break;
6528 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6529 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
6530 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
6531 break;
6532 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6533 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6534 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6535 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
6536 break;
6537 case bp_watchpoint:
6538 case bp_catchpoint:
6539 case bp_tracepoint:
6540 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6541 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6542 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
6543 break;
6544 default:
6545 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
6546 }
6547
6548 loc->refc = 1;
6549 }
6550
6551 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
6552
6553 static struct bp_location *
6554 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
6555 {
6556 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
6557 }
6558
6559 static void
6560 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
6561 {
6562 loc->ops->dtor (loc);
6563 xfree (loc);
6564 }
6565
6566 /* Increment reference count. */
6567
6568 static void
6569 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
6570 {
6571 ++bl->refc;
6572 }
6573
6574 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
6575 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
6576
6577 static void
6578 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
6579 {
6580 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
6581
6582 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
6583 free_bp_location (*blp);
6584 *blp = NULL;
6585 }
6586
6587 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
6588
6589 static void
6590 add_to_breakpoint_chain (struct breakpoint *b)
6591 {
6592 struct breakpoint *b1;
6593
6594 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
6595 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
6596
6597 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
6598 if (b1 == 0)
6599 breakpoint_chain = b;
6600 else
6601 {
6602 while (b1->next)
6603 b1 = b1->next;
6604 b1->next = b;
6605 }
6606 }
6607
6608 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
6609
6610 static void
6611 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6612 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6613 enum bptype bptype,
6614 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6615 {
6616 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
6617
6618 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
6619
6620 b->ops = ops;
6621 b->type = bptype;
6622 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
6623 b->language = current_language->la_language;
6624 b->input_radix = input_radix;
6625 b->thread = -1;
6626 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6627 b->next = 0;
6628 b->silent = 0;
6629 b->ignore_count = 0;
6630 b->commands = NULL;
6631 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
6632 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
6633 b->py_bp_object = NULL;
6634 b->related_breakpoint = b;
6635 }
6636
6637 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
6638 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
6639
6640 static struct breakpoint *
6641 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6642 enum bptype bptype,
6643 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6644 {
6645 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
6646
6647 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
6648 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
6649 return b;
6650 }
6651
6652 /* Initialize loc->function_name. EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function
6653 resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly
6654 enough. */
6655
6656 static void
6657 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc)
6658 {
6659 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
6660
6661 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
6662 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
6663 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
6664 {
6665 int is_gnu_ifunc;
6666 const char *function_name;
6667 CORE_ADDR func_addr;
6668
6669 find_pc_partial_function_gnu_ifunc (loc->address, &function_name,
6670 &func_addr, NULL, &is_gnu_ifunc);
6671
6672 if (is_gnu_ifunc && !explicit_loc)
6673 {
6674 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
6675
6676 gdb_assert (loc->pspace == current_program_space);
6677 if (gnu_ifunc_resolve_name (function_name,
6678 &loc->requested_address))
6679 {
6680 /* Recalculate ADDRESS based on new REQUESTED_ADDRESS. */
6681 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
6682 loc->requested_address,
6683 b->type);
6684 }
6685 else if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
6686 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
6687 {
6688 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
6689 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
6690 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
6691 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
6692 breakpoint. */
6693 loc->related_address = func_addr;
6694 }
6695 }
6696
6697 if (function_name)
6698 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
6699 }
6700 }
6701
6702 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
6703 struct gdbarch *
6704 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
6705 {
6706 if (sal.section)
6707 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
6708 if (sal.symtab)
6709 return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
6710
6711 return NULL;
6712 }
6713
6714 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
6715 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
6716 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
6717
6718 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
6719 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
6720 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
6721
6722 static void
6723 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6724 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
6725 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6726 {
6727 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
6728
6729 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
6730
6731 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
6732 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
6733
6734 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
6735 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
6736 program space. */
6737 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6738 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
6739
6740 breakpoints_changed ();
6741 }
6742
6743 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
6744 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
6745 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
6746 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
6747 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
6748 is also returned as the value of this function.
6749
6750 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
6751 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
6752 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
6753 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
6754 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
6755 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
6756 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
6757
6758 struct breakpoint *
6759 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6760 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
6761 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6762 {
6763 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
6764
6765 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
6766 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
6767 return b;
6768 }
6769
6770
6771 /* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
6772 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
6773 void
6774 make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
6775 {
6776 struct bp_location *bl;
6777
6778 b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
6779
6780 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
6781 code. Mark all locations as inserted. For now,
6782 make_breakpoint_permanent is called in just one place, so it's
6783 hard to say if it's reasonable to have permanent breakpoint with
6784 multiple locations or not, but it's easy to implement. */
6785 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
6786 bl->inserted = 1;
6787 }
6788
6789 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
6790 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
6791 initiated the operation. */
6792
6793 void
6794 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
6795 {
6796 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
6797 int thread = tp->num;
6798
6799 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
6800 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
6801 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
6802 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
6803 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
6804 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
6805 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
6806 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
6807 {
6808 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
6809 struct breakpoint *clone;
6810
6811 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
6812 after their removal. */
6813 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
6814 &longjmp_breakpoint_ops);
6815 clone->thread = thread;
6816 }
6817
6818 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
6819 }
6820
6821 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
6822 void
6823 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
6824 {
6825 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
6826
6827 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
6828 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
6829 {
6830 if (b->thread == thread)
6831 delete_breakpoint (b);
6832 }
6833 }
6834
6835 void
6836 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
6837 {
6838 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
6839
6840 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
6841 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
6842 {
6843 if (b->thread == thread)
6844 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
6845 }
6846 }
6847
6848 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
6849 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
6850 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
6851 breakpoints. */
6852
6853 struct breakpoint *
6854 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
6855 {
6856 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
6857
6858 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6859 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
6860 {
6861 struct breakpoint *new_b;
6862
6863 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
6864 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
6865 new_b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
6866
6867 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
6868
6869 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
6870 if (retval == NULL)
6871 retval = new_b;
6872 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
6873 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
6874 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
6875 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
6876 }
6877
6878 return retval;
6879 }
6880
6881 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
6882 THREAD. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
6883 stack.
6884
6885 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
6886 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
6887 frames. */
6888
6889 void
6890 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (int thread)
6891 {
6892 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
6893
6894 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
6895 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == thread)
6896 {
6897 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
6898
6899 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
6900 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
6901 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
6902 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
6903 continue;
6904
6905 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id);
6906
6907 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
6908 {
6909 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
6910 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
6911 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
6912 }
6913 delete_breakpoint (b);
6914 }
6915 }
6916
6917 void
6918 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
6919 {
6920 struct breakpoint *b;
6921
6922 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6923 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
6924 {
6925 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6926 update_global_location_list (1);
6927 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
6928 }
6929 }
6930
6931 void
6932 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
6933 {
6934 struct breakpoint *b;
6935
6936 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6937 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
6938 {
6939 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
6940 update_global_location_list (0);
6941 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
6942 }
6943 }
6944
6945 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
6946 master breakpoint. */
6947 void
6948 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
6949 {
6950 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
6951
6952 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
6953 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
6954 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
6955 {
6956 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
6957 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
6958 }
6959 }
6960
6961 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
6962 void
6963 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
6964 {
6965 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
6966
6967 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
6968 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
6969 delete_breakpoint (b);
6970 }
6971
6972 struct breakpoint *
6973 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
6974 {
6975 struct breakpoint *b;
6976
6977 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
6978 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
6979
6980 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6981 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
6982 b->addr_string
6983 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
6984
6985 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
6986
6987 return b;
6988 }
6989
6990 void
6991 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
6992 {
6993 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
6994
6995 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
6996 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
6997 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
6998 delete_breakpoint (b);
6999 }
7000
7001 struct lang_and_radix
7002 {
7003 enum language lang;
7004 int radix;
7005 };
7006
7007 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7008
7009 struct breakpoint *
7010 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7011 {
7012 struct breakpoint *b;
7013
7014 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7015 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7016 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
7017 return b;
7018 }
7019
7020 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7021
7022 void
7023 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7024 {
7025 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7026
7027 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7028 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7029 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7030 delete_breakpoint (b);
7031 }
7032
7033 void
7034 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7035 {
7036 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7037
7038 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7039 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7040 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7041 delete_breakpoint (b);
7042 }
7043
7044 struct breakpoint *
7045 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7046 {
7047 struct breakpoint *b;
7048
7049 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7050 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7051 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
7052 return b;
7053 }
7054
7055 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7056 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7057
7058 void
7059 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7060 {
7061 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7062
7063 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7064 {
7065 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7066 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7067
7068 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7069 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7070 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7071 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7072 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7073 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7074 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7075 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7076 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7077 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7078 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7079 #ifdef PC_SOLIB
7080 && PC_SOLIB (loc->address)
7081 #else
7082 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7083 #endif
7084 )
7085 {
7086 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7087 }
7088 }
7089 }
7090
7091 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in an unloaded shared
7092 library. Only apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay
7093 disabled. */
7094
7095 static void
7096 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7097 {
7098 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7099 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7100
7101 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
7102 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
7103 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
7104 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
7105 if (exec_bfd != NULL
7106 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
7107 return;
7108
7109 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7110 {
7111 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7112 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7113
7114 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7115 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7116 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7117 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7118 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7119 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7120 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7121 || is_tracepoint (b))
7122 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7123 {
7124 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7125 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7126 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7127 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7128 loc->inserted = 0;
7129
7130 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7131 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7132
7133 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7134 {
7135 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
7136 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7137 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7138 solib->so_name);
7139 }
7140 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7141 }
7142 }
7143 }
7144
7145 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7146
7147 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7148 catchpoint. It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base
7149 class; users downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A
7150 breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7151 CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7152
7153 struct fork_catchpoint
7154 {
7155 /* The base class. */
7156 struct breakpoint base;
7157
7158 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7159 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7160 catchpoint has triggered. */
7161 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7162 };
7163
7164 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7165 catchpoints. */
7166
7167 static int
7168 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7169 {
7170 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
7171 }
7172
7173 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7174 catchpoints. */
7175
7176 static int
7177 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7178 {
7179 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
7180 }
7181
7182 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7183 catchpoints. */
7184
7185 static int
7186 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7187 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7188 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7189 {
7190 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7191
7192 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7193 return 0;
7194
7195 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7196 return 1;
7197 }
7198
7199 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7200 catchpoints. */
7201
7202 static enum print_stop_action
7203 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
7204 {
7205 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7206 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7207 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7208
7209 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7210 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7211 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
7212 else
7213 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
7214 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7215 {
7216 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7217 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
7218 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7219 }
7220 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7221 ui_out_text (uiout, " (forked process ");
7222 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7223 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
7224 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7225 }
7226
7227 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7228 catchpoints. */
7229
7230 static void
7231 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7232 {
7233 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7234 struct value_print_options opts;
7235 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7236
7237 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7238
7239 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7240 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7241 readable). */
7242 if (opts.addressprint)
7243 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
7244 annotate_field (5);
7245 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
7246 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
7247 {
7248 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
7249 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
7250 ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7251 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
7252 }
7253 }
7254
7255 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7256 catchpoints. */
7257
7258 static void
7259 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
7260 {
7261 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
7262 }
7263
7264 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7265 catchpoints. */
7266
7267 static void
7268 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7269 {
7270 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
7271 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7272 }
7273
7274 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
7275
7276 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
7277
7278 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7279 catchpoints. */
7280
7281 static int
7282 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
7283 {
7284 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
7285 }
7286
7287 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7288 catchpoints. */
7289
7290 static int
7291 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
7292 {
7293 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
7294 }
7295
7296 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7297 catchpoints. */
7298
7299 static int
7300 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7301 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7302 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7303 {
7304 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7305
7306 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
7307 return 0;
7308
7309 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7310 return 1;
7311 }
7312
7313 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7314 catchpoints. */
7315
7316 static enum print_stop_action
7317 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
7318 {
7319 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7320 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7321 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7322
7323 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7324 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7325 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
7326 else
7327 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
7328 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7329 {
7330 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7331 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
7332 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7333 }
7334 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7335 ui_out_text (uiout, " (vforked process ");
7336 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7337 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
7338 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7339 }
7340
7341 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7342 catchpoints. */
7343
7344 static void
7345 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7346 {
7347 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7348 struct value_print_options opts;
7349 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7350
7351 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7352 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7353 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7354 readable). */
7355 if (opts.addressprint)
7356 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
7357 annotate_field (5);
7358 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
7359 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
7360 {
7361 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
7362 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
7363 ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7364 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
7365 }
7366 }
7367
7368 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7369 catchpoints. */
7370
7371 static void
7372 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
7373 {
7374 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
7375 }
7376
7377 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7378 catchpoints. */
7379
7380 static void
7381 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7382 {
7383 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
7384 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7385 }
7386
7387 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
7388
7389 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
7390
7391 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
7392 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
7393 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
7394 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7395 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7396
7397 struct solib_catchpoint
7398 {
7399 /* The base class. */
7400 struct breakpoint base;
7401
7402 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
7403 unsigned char is_load;
7404
7405 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
7406 REGEX is non-NULL. */
7407 char *regex;
7408 regex_t compiled;
7409 };
7410
7411 static void
7412 dtor_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
7413 {
7414 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
7415
7416 if (self->regex)
7417 regfree (&self->compiled);
7418 xfree (self->regex);
7419
7420 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
7421 }
7422
7423 static int
7424 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
7425 {
7426 return 0;
7427 }
7428
7429 static int
7430 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
7431 {
7432 return 0;
7433 }
7434
7435 static int
7436 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
7437 struct address_space *aspace,
7438 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7439 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7440 {
7441 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7442 struct breakpoint *other;
7443
7444 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
7445 return 1;
7446
7447 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
7448 {
7449 struct bp_location *other_bl;
7450
7451 if (other == bl->owner)
7452 continue;
7453
7454 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
7455 continue;
7456
7457 if (self->base.pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->base.pspace)
7458 continue;
7459
7460 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
7461 {
7462 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
7463 return 1;
7464 }
7465 }
7466
7467 return 0;
7468 }
7469
7470 static void
7471 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
7472 {
7473 struct solib_catchpoint *self
7474 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7475 int ix;
7476
7477 if (self->is_load)
7478 {
7479 struct so_list *iter;
7480
7481 for (ix = 0;
7482 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
7483 ix, iter);
7484 ++ix)
7485 {
7486 if (!self->regex
7487 || regexec (&self->compiled, iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
7488 return;
7489 }
7490 }
7491 else
7492 {
7493 char *iter;
7494
7495 for (ix = 0;
7496 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
7497 ix, iter);
7498 ++ix)
7499 {
7500 if (!self->regex
7501 || regexec (&self->compiled, iter, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
7502 return;
7503 }
7504 }
7505
7506 bs->stop = 0;
7507 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
7508 }
7509
7510 static enum print_stop_action
7511 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
7512 {
7513 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7514 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7515
7516 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7517 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7518 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
7519 else
7520 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
7521 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7522 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
7523 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7524 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7525 print_solib_event (1);
7526 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7527 }
7528
7529 static void
7530 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
7531 {
7532 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
7533 struct value_print_options opts;
7534 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7535 char *msg;
7536
7537 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7538 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7539 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7540 readable). */
7541 if (opts.addressprint)
7542 {
7543 annotate_field (4);
7544 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
7545 }
7546
7547 annotate_field (5);
7548 if (self->is_load)
7549 {
7550 if (self->regex)
7551 msg = xstrprintf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
7552 else
7553 msg = xstrdup (_("load of library"));
7554 }
7555 else
7556 {
7557 if (self->regex)
7558 msg = xstrprintf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
7559 else
7560 msg = xstrdup (_("unload of library"));
7561 }
7562 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
7563 xfree (msg);
7564 }
7565
7566 static void
7567 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
7568 {
7569 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
7570
7571 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
7572 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
7573 }
7574
7575 static void
7576 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7577 {
7578 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
7579
7580 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
7581 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
7582 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
7583 if (self->regex)
7584 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
7585 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
7586 }
7587
7588 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
7589
7590 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
7591 "catch unload". */
7592
7593 static void
7594 catch_load_or_unload (char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
7595 struct cmd_list_element *command)
7596 {
7597 struct solib_catchpoint *c;
7598 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7599 int tempflag;
7600 struct cleanup *cleanup;
7601
7602 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7603
7604 if (!arg)
7605 arg = "";
7606 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
7607
7608 c = XCNEW (struct solib_catchpoint);
7609 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, c);
7610
7611 if (*arg != '\0')
7612 {
7613 int errcode;
7614
7615 errcode = regcomp (&c->compiled, arg, REG_NOSUB);
7616 if (errcode != 0)
7617 {
7618 char *err = get_regcomp_error (errcode, &c->compiled);
7619
7620 make_cleanup (xfree, err);
7621 error (_("Invalid regexp (%s): %s"), err, arg);
7622 }
7623 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
7624 }
7625
7626 c->is_load = is_load;
7627 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, NULL,
7628 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
7629
7630 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
7631 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
7632 }
7633
7634 static void
7635 catch_load_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
7636 struct cmd_list_element *command)
7637 {
7638 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
7639 }
7640
7641 static void
7642 catch_unload_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
7643 struct cmd_list_element *command)
7644 {
7645 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
7646 }
7647
7648 DEF_VEC_I(int);
7649
7650 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a syscall catchpoint.
7651 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
7652 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
7653 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7654 CATCH_SYSCALL_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7655
7656 struct syscall_catchpoint
7657 {
7658 /* The base class. */
7659 struct breakpoint base;
7660
7661 /* Syscall numbers used for the 'catch syscall' feature. If no
7662 syscall has been specified for filtering, its value is NULL.
7663 Otherwise, it holds a list of all syscalls to be caught. The
7664 list elements are allocated with xmalloc. */
7665 VEC(int) *syscalls_to_be_caught;
7666 };
7667
7668 /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
7669 catchpoints. */
7670
7671 static void
7672 dtor_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
7673 {
7674 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) b;
7675
7676 VEC_free (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught);
7677
7678 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
7679 }
7680
7681 static const struct inferior_data *catch_syscall_inferior_data = NULL;
7682
7683 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data
7684 {
7685 /* We keep a count of the number of times the user has requested a
7686 particular syscall to be tracked, and pass this information to the
7687 target. This lets capable targets implement filtering directly. */
7688
7689 /* Number of times that "any" syscall is requested. */
7690 int any_syscall_count;
7691
7692 /* Count of each system call. */
7693 VEC(int) *syscalls_counts;
7694
7695 /* This counts all syscall catch requests, so we can readily determine
7696 if any catching is necessary. */
7697 int total_syscalls_count;
7698 };
7699
7700 static struct catch_syscall_inferior_data*
7701 get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (struct inferior *inf)
7702 {
7703 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data;
7704
7705 inf_data = inferior_data (inf, catch_syscall_inferior_data);
7706 if (inf_data == NULL)
7707 {
7708 inf_data = XZALLOC (struct catch_syscall_inferior_data);
7709 set_inferior_data (inf, catch_syscall_inferior_data, inf_data);
7710 }
7711
7712 return inf_data;
7713 }
7714
7715 static void
7716 catch_syscall_inferior_data_cleanup (struct inferior *inf, void *arg)
7717 {
7718 xfree (arg);
7719 }
7720
7721
7722 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
7723 catchpoints. */
7724
7725 static int
7726 insert_catch_syscall (struct bp_location *bl)
7727 {
7728 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7729 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
7730 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data
7731 = get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (inf);
7732
7733 ++inf_data->total_syscalls_count;
7734 if (!c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
7735 ++inf_data->any_syscall_count;
7736 else
7737 {
7738 int i, iter;
7739
7740 for (i = 0;
7741 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
7742 i++)
7743 {
7744 int elem;
7745
7746 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts))
7747 {
7748 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts);
7749 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset
7750 = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
7751 uintptr_t vec_addr;
7752 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
7753 vec_addr = ((uintptr_t) VEC_address (int,
7754 inf_data->syscalls_counts)
7755 + vec_addr_offset);
7756 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
7757 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
7758 }
7759 elem = VEC_index (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter);
7760 VEC_replace (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
7761 }
7762 }
7763
7764 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
7765 inf_data->total_syscalls_count != 0,
7766 inf_data->any_syscall_count,
7767 VEC_length (int,
7768 inf_data->syscalls_counts),
7769 VEC_address (int,
7770 inf_data->syscalls_counts));
7771 }
7772
7773 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
7774 catchpoints. */
7775
7776 static int
7777 remove_catch_syscall (struct bp_location *bl)
7778 {
7779 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7780 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
7781 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data
7782 = get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (inf);
7783
7784 --inf_data->total_syscalls_count;
7785 if (!c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
7786 --inf_data->any_syscall_count;
7787 else
7788 {
7789 int i, iter;
7790
7791 for (i = 0;
7792 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
7793 i++)
7794 {
7795 int elem;
7796 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts))
7797 /* Shouldn't happen. */
7798 continue;
7799 elem = VEC_index (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter);
7800 VEC_replace (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
7801 }
7802 }
7803
7804 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
7805 inf_data->total_syscalls_count != 0,
7806 inf_data->any_syscall_count,
7807 VEC_length (int,
7808 inf_data->syscalls_counts),
7809 VEC_address (int,
7810 inf_data->syscalls_counts));
7811 }
7812
7813 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
7814 catchpoints. */
7815
7816 static int
7817 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (const struct bp_location *bl,
7818 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7819 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7820 {
7821 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this
7822 breakpoint. If we are, then we must guarantee that the called
7823 syscall is the same syscall we are catching. */
7824 int syscall_number = 0;
7825 const struct syscall_catchpoint *c
7826 = (const struct syscall_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7827
7828 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
7829 && ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
7830 return 0;
7831
7832 syscall_number = ws->value.syscall_number;
7833
7834 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
7835 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
7836 {
7837 int i, iter;
7838
7839 for (i = 0;
7840 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
7841 i++)
7842 if (syscall_number == iter)
7843 break;
7844 /* Not the same. */
7845 if (!iter)
7846 return 0;
7847 }
7848
7849 return 1;
7850 }
7851
7852 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
7853 catchpoints. */
7854
7855 static enum print_stop_action
7856 print_it_catch_syscall (bpstat bs)
7857 {
7858 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7859 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7860 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
7861 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
7862 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
7863 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
7864 ptid_t ptid;
7865 struct target_waitstatus last;
7866 struct syscall s;
7867
7868 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
7869
7870 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
7871
7872 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7873
7874 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7875 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
7876 else
7877 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
7878 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7879 {
7880 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7881 async_reason_lookup (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
7882 ? EXEC_ASYNC_SYSCALL_ENTRY
7883 : EXEC_ASYNC_SYSCALL_RETURN));
7884 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7885 }
7886 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7887
7888 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
7889 ui_out_text (uiout, " (call to syscall ");
7890 else
7891 ui_out_text (uiout, " (returned from syscall ");
7892
7893 if (s.name == NULL || ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7894 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "syscall-number", last.value.syscall_number);
7895 if (s.name != NULL)
7896 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "syscall-name", s.name);
7897
7898 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
7899
7900 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7901 }
7902
7903 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
7904 catchpoints. */
7905
7906 static void
7907 print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
7908 struct bp_location **last_loc)
7909 {
7910 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) b;
7911 struct value_print_options opts;
7912 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7913
7914 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7915 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7916 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7917 readable). */
7918 if (opts.addressprint)
7919 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
7920 annotate_field (5);
7921
7922 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught
7923 && VEC_length (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
7924 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
7925 else
7926 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
7927
7928 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
7929 {
7930 int i, iter;
7931 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
7932
7933 for (i = 0;
7934 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
7935 i++)
7936 {
7937 char *x = text;
7938 struct syscall s;
7939 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
7940
7941 if (s.name != NULL)
7942 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
7943 else
7944 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
7945
7946 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
7947 because xstrprintf dynamically allocates new space for it
7948 on every call. */
7949 xfree (x);
7950 }
7951 /* Remove the last comma. */
7952 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
7953 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
7954 }
7955 else
7956 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
7957 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
7958 }
7959
7960 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
7961 catchpoints. */
7962
7963 static void
7964 print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
7965 {
7966 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) b;
7967
7968 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
7969 {
7970 int i, iter;
7971
7972 if (VEC_length (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
7973 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
7974 else
7975 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
7976
7977 for (i = 0;
7978 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
7979 i++)
7980 {
7981 struct syscall s;
7982 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
7983
7984 if (s.name)
7985 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
7986 else
7987 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
7988 }
7989 printf_filtered (")");
7990 }
7991 else
7992 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
7993 b->number);
7994 }
7995
7996 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
7997 catchpoints. */
7998
7999 static void
8000 print_recreate_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8001 {
8002 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) b;
8003
8004 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch syscall");
8005
8006 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
8007 {
8008 int i, iter;
8009
8010 for (i = 0;
8011 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
8012 i++)
8013 {
8014 struct syscall s;
8015
8016 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
8017 if (s.name)
8018 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", s.name);
8019 else
8020 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %d", s.number);
8021 }
8022 }
8023 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8024 }
8025
8026 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
8027
8028 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops;
8029
8030 /* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
8031
8032 static int
8033 syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
8034 {
8035 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
8036 }
8037
8038 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8039 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8040 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8041 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8042
8043 static void
8044 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8045 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8046 char *cond_string,
8047 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8048 {
8049 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8050
8051 init_sal (&sal);
8052 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8053
8054 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8055
8056 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8057 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8058 }
8059
8060 void
8061 install_breakpoint (int internal, struct breakpoint *b, int update_gll)
8062 {
8063 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
8064 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8065 if (!internal)
8066 mention (b);
8067 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
8068
8069 if (update_gll)
8070 update_global_location_list (1);
8071 }
8072
8073 static void
8074 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8075 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
8076 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8077 {
8078 struct fork_catchpoint *c = XNEW (struct fork_catchpoint);
8079
8080 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8081
8082 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8083
8084 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8085 }
8086
8087 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8088
8089 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8090 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8091 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8092 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8093 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8094
8095 struct exec_catchpoint
8096 {
8097 /* The base class. */
8098 struct breakpoint base;
8099
8100 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8101 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8102 triggered. */
8103 char *exec_pathname;
8104 };
8105
8106 /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8107 catchpoints. */
8108
8109 static void
8110 dtor_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8111 {
8112 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8113
8114 xfree (c->exec_pathname);
8115
8116 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8117 }
8118
8119 static int
8120 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8121 {
8122 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
8123 }
8124
8125 static int
8126 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8127 {
8128 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
8129 }
8130
8131 static int
8132 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8133 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8134 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8135 {
8136 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8137
8138 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8139 return 0;
8140
8141 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8142 return 1;
8143 }
8144
8145 static enum print_stop_action
8146 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8147 {
8148 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8149 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8150 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8151
8152 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8153 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8154 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8155 else
8156 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8157 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8158 {
8159 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8160 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8161 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8162 }
8163 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8164 ui_out_text (uiout, " (exec'd ");
8165 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8166 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8167
8168 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8169 }
8170
8171 static void
8172 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8173 {
8174 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8175 struct value_print_options opts;
8176 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8177
8178 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8179
8180 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8181 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8182 is relatively readable). */
8183 if (opts.addressprint)
8184 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8185 annotate_field (5);
8186 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
8187 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8188 {
8189 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
8190 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", c->exec_pathname);
8191 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
8192 }
8193 }
8194
8195 static void
8196 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8197 {
8198 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8199 }
8200
8201 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8202 catchpoints. */
8203
8204 static void
8205 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8206 {
8207 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8208 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8209 }
8210
8211 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8212
8213 static void
8214 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
8215 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8216 {
8217 struct syscall_catchpoint *c;
8218 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8219
8220 c = XNEW (struct syscall_catchpoint);
8221 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
8222 c->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
8223
8224 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8225 }
8226
8227 static int
8228 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8229 {
8230 int i = 0;
8231 struct breakpoint *b;
8232 struct bp_location *bl;
8233
8234 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8235 {
8236 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8237 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8238 {
8239 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8240 one register. */
8241 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8242 }
8243 }
8244
8245 return i;
8246 }
8247
8248 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8249 watchpoint. */
8250
8251 static int
8252 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8253 {
8254 int i = 0;
8255 struct bp_location *bl;
8256
8257 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8258 return 0;
8259
8260 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8261 {
8262 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8263 one register. */
8264 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8265 }
8266
8267 return i;
8268 }
8269
8270 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8271 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8272 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8273 types _not_ TYPE. */
8274
8275 static int
8276 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8277 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8278 {
8279 int i = 0;
8280 struct breakpoint *b;
8281
8282 *other_type_used = 0;
8283 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8284 {
8285 if (b == except)
8286 continue;
8287 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8288 continue;
8289
8290 if (b->type == type)
8291 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8292 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8293 *other_type_used = 1;
8294 }
8295
8296 return i;
8297 }
8298
8299 void
8300 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8301 {
8302 struct breakpoint *b;
8303
8304 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8305 {
8306 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8307 {
8308 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8309 update_global_location_list (0);
8310 }
8311 }
8312 }
8313
8314 void
8315 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8316 {
8317 struct breakpoint *b;
8318
8319 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8320 {
8321 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8322 {
8323 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8324 update_global_location_list (1);
8325 }
8326 }
8327 }
8328
8329 void
8330 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8331 {
8332 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8333 update_global_location_list (0);
8334 }
8335
8336 void
8337 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8338 {
8339 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8340 breakpoint_re_set ();
8341 }
8342
8343
8344 /* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
8345 at address specified by SAL.
8346 Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero. */
8347
8348 struct breakpoint *
8349 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8350 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8351 {
8352 struct breakpoint *b;
8353
8354 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined
8355 one. */
8356 gdb_assert (!frame_id_inlined_p (frame_id));
8357
8358 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8359 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8360 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8361 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8362
8363 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we want
8364 momentary breakpoints to be active in only a single thread of
8365 control. */
8366 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
8367 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
8368
8369 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
8370
8371 return b;
8372 }
8373
8374 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8375 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, and use OPS as it
8376 breakpoint_ops. */
8377
8378 static struct breakpoint *
8379 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8380 enum bptype type,
8381 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8382 {
8383 struct breakpoint *copy;
8384
8385 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8386 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8387 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1);
8388
8389 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8390 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8391 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8392 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8393 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8394 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8395
8396 if (orig->loc->source_file != NULL)
8397 copy->loc->source_file = xstrdup (orig->loc->source_file);
8398
8399 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8400 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8401 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8402 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8403
8404 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8405 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8406 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8407
8408 update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
8409 return copy;
8410 }
8411
8412 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8413 ORIG is NULL. */
8414
8415 struct breakpoint *
8416 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
8417 {
8418 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8419 if (orig == NULL)
8420 return NULL;
8421
8422 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops);
8423 }
8424
8425 struct breakpoint *
8426 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
8427 enum bptype type)
8428 {
8429 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8430
8431 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8432 sal.pc = pc;
8433 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
8434 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8435
8436 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
8437 }
8438 \f
8439
8440 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8441
8442 static void
8443 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
8444 {
8445 b->ops->print_mention (b);
8446 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
8447 return;
8448 printf_filtered ("\n");
8449 }
8450 \f
8451
8452 static struct bp_location *
8453 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8454 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8455 {
8456 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
8457 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
8458 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
8459
8460 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
8461 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
8462
8463 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8464 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8465 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8466 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8467 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8468 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8469 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
8470 sal->pc, b->type);
8471
8472 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
8473 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
8474 ;
8475 *tmp = loc;
8476
8477 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
8478 loc->address = adjusted_address;
8479 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
8480 loc->probe = sal->probe;
8481 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
8482 loc->section = sal->section;
8483 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
8484
8485 if (sal->symtab != NULL)
8486 loc->source_file = xstrdup (sal->symtab->filename);
8487 loc->line_number = sal->line;
8488
8489 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc,
8490 sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line);
8491 return loc;
8492 }
8493 \f
8494
8495 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
8496 return 0 otherwise. */
8497
8498 static int
8499 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
8500 {
8501 int len;
8502 CORE_ADDR addr;
8503 const gdb_byte *bpoint;
8504 gdb_byte *target_mem;
8505 struct cleanup *cleanup;
8506 int retval = 0;
8507
8508 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
8509
8510 addr = loc->address;
8511 bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
8512
8513 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
8514 if (bpoint == NULL)
8515 return 0;
8516
8517 target_mem = alloca (len);
8518
8519 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
8520 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
8521 breakpoints they are permanent. */
8522 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
8523
8524 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
8525 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
8526
8527 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
8528 && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0)
8529 retval = 1;
8530
8531 do_cleanups (cleanup);
8532
8533 return retval;
8534 }
8535
8536 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
8537 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
8538 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
8539 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
8540 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
8541 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. (Future
8542 styles may include the ability to do a target-side printf.) */
8543
8544 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
8545 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
8546 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
8547 dprintf_style_gdb,
8548 dprintf_style_call,
8549 NULL
8550 };
8551 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
8552
8553 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
8554 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
8555 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
8556 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
8557
8558 static char *dprintf_function = "";
8559
8560 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
8561 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
8562 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
8563 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
8564 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
8565 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
8566 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
8567
8568 static char *dprintf_channel = "";
8569
8570 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
8571 settings of the dprintf style options. */
8572
8573 static void
8574 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
8575 {
8576 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
8577 char *printf_line = NULL;
8578
8579 if (!dprintf_args)
8580 return;
8581
8582 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8583
8584 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
8585 insist on it. */
8586 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
8587 ++dprintf_args;
8588 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8589
8590 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
8591 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
8592
8593 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, "gdb") == 0)
8594 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8595 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, "call") == 0)
8596 {
8597 if (!dprintf_function)
8598 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
8599
8600 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
8601 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
8602 dprintf_function,
8603 dprintf_channel,
8604 dprintf_args);
8605 else
8606 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
8607 dprintf_function,
8608 dprintf_args);
8609 }
8610 else
8611 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8612 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
8613
8614 /* Manufacture a printf/continue sequence. */
8615 if (printf_line)
8616 {
8617 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line, *cont_cmd_line = NULL;
8618
8619 cont_cmd_line = xmalloc (sizeof (struct command_line));
8620 cont_cmd_line->control_type = simple_control;
8621 cont_cmd_line->body_count = 0;
8622 cont_cmd_line->body_list = NULL;
8623 cont_cmd_line->next = NULL;
8624 cont_cmd_line->line = xstrdup ("continue");
8625
8626 printf_cmd_line = xmalloc (sizeof (struct command_line));
8627 printf_cmd_line->control_type = simple_control;
8628 printf_cmd_line->body_count = 0;
8629 printf_cmd_line->body_list = NULL;
8630 printf_cmd_line->next = cont_cmd_line;
8631 printf_cmd_line->line = printf_line;
8632
8633 breakpoint_set_commands (b, printf_cmd_line);
8634 }
8635 }
8636
8637 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
8638 current style settings. */
8639
8640 static void
8641 update_dprintf_commands (char *args, int from_tty,
8642 struct cmd_list_element *c)
8643 {
8644 struct breakpoint *b;
8645
8646 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8647 {
8648 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
8649 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8650 }
8651 }
8652
8653 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
8654 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
8655 as condition expression. */
8656
8657 static void
8658 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8659 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
8660 char *filter, char *cond_string,
8661 char *extra_string,
8662 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8663 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8664 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8665 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8666 int display_canonical)
8667 {
8668 int i;
8669
8670 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
8671 {
8672 int target_resources_ok;
8673
8674 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
8675 target_resources_ok =
8676 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
8677 i + 1, 0);
8678 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
8679 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
8680 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
8681 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
8682 }
8683
8684 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
8685
8686 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
8687 {
8688 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
8689 struct bp_location *loc;
8690
8691 if (from_tty)
8692 {
8693 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8694 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8695 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8696
8697 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8698 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
8699 }
8700
8701 if (i == 0)
8702 {
8703 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
8704 b->thread = thread;
8705 b->task = task;
8706
8707 b->cond_string = cond_string;
8708 b->extra_string = extra_string;
8709 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
8710 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8711 b->disposition = disposition;
8712
8713 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8714 b->loc->inserted = 1;
8715
8716 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
8717 {
8718 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
8719 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
8720
8721 if (strace_marker_p (b))
8722 {
8723 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
8724 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
8725 char *p = &addr_string[3];
8726 char *endp;
8727 char *marker_str;
8728
8729 p = skip_spaces (p);
8730
8731 endp = skip_to_space (p);
8732
8733 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
8734 t->static_trace_marker_id = marker_str;
8735
8736 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8737 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8738 t->static_trace_marker_id);
8739 }
8740 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
8741 {
8742 t->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
8743 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
8744
8745 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8746 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8747 t->static_trace_marker_id);
8748 }
8749 else
8750 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
8751 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
8752 }
8753
8754 loc = b->loc;
8755 }
8756 else
8757 {
8758 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
8759 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8760 loc->inserted = 1;
8761 }
8762
8763 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
8764 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
8765
8766 if (b->cond_string)
8767 {
8768 char *arg = b->cond_string;
8769 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
8770 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
8771 if (*arg)
8772 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
8773 }
8774
8775 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
8776 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
8777 if (type == bp_dprintf)
8778 {
8779 if (b->extra_string)
8780 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8781 else
8782 error (_("Format string required"));
8783 }
8784 else if (b->extra_string)
8785 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
8786 }
8787
8788 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
8789 if (addr_string)
8790 b->addr_string = addr_string;
8791 else
8792 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
8793 me. */
8794 b->addr_string
8795 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
8796 b->filter = filter;
8797 }
8798
8799 static void
8800 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8801 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
8802 char *filter, char *cond_string,
8803 char *extra_string,
8804 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8805 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8806 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8807 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8808 int display_canonical)
8809 {
8810 struct breakpoint *b;
8811 struct cleanup *old_chain;
8812
8813 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
8814 {
8815 struct tracepoint *t;
8816
8817 t = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
8818 b = &t->base;
8819 }
8820 else
8821 b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
8822
8823 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, b);
8824
8825 init_breakpoint_sal (b, gdbarch,
8826 sals, addr_string,
8827 filter, cond_string, extra_string,
8828 type, disposition,
8829 thread, task, ignore_count,
8830 ops, from_tty,
8831 enabled, internal, flags,
8832 display_canonical);
8833 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
8834
8835 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0);
8836 }
8837
8838 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
8839 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
8840 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
8841 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
8842 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
8843 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
8844 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
8845 we take just a single condition string.
8846
8847 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
8848 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
8849 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
8850 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
8851 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
8852
8853 static void
8854 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8855 struct linespec_result *canonical,
8856 char *cond_string, char *extra_string,
8857 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8858 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8859 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8860 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
8861 {
8862 int i;
8863 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
8864
8865 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
8866 gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical->sals) == 1);
8867
8868 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, i, lsal); ++i)
8869 {
8870 /* Note that 'addr_string' can be NULL in the case of a plain
8871 'break', without arguments. */
8872 char *addr_string = (canonical->addr_string
8873 ? xstrdup (canonical->addr_string)
8874 : NULL);
8875 char *filter_string = lsal->canonical ? xstrdup (lsal->canonical) : NULL;
8876 struct cleanup *inner = make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
8877
8878 make_cleanup (xfree, filter_string);
8879 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal->sals,
8880 addr_string,
8881 filter_string,
8882 cond_string, extra_string,
8883 type, disposition,
8884 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
8885 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
8886 canonical->special_display);
8887 discard_cleanups (inner);
8888 }
8889 }
8890
8891 /* Parse ADDRESS which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
8892 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
8893 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
8894 address strings. ADDRESS points to the end of the SAL.
8895
8896 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
8897 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
8898
8899 static void
8900 parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
8901 struct linespec_result *canonical)
8902 {
8903 char *addr_start = *address;
8904
8905 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
8906 breakpoint. */
8907 if ((*address) == NULL
8908 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
8909 {
8910 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default breakpoint
8911 address. */
8912 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
8913 {
8914 struct linespec_sals lsal;
8915 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8916
8917 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
8918 lsal.sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
8919 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
8920
8921 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
8922 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. */
8923 get_last_displayed_sal (&sal);
8924 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
8925
8926 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
8927 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
8928 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
8929 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
8930 instances with the same symtab and line. */
8931 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8932
8933 lsal.sals.sals[0] = sal;
8934 lsal.sals.nelts = 1;
8935 lsal.canonical = NULL;
8936
8937 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
8938 }
8939 else
8940 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
8941 }
8942 else
8943 {
8944 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
8945
8946 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
8947 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
8948 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
8949 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
8950
8951 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
8952 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
8953 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
8954 && (!cursal.symtab
8955 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
8956 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
8957 decode_line_full (address, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
8958 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
8959 get_last_displayed_line (),
8960 canonical, NULL, NULL);
8961 else
8962 decode_line_full (address, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
8963 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
8964 }
8965 }
8966
8967
8968 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
8969 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
8970
8971 static void
8972 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
8973 {
8974 int i;
8975
8976 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
8977 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
8978 }
8979
8980 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
8981 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
8982 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
8983 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
8984 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
8985 it, etc. */
8986
8987 static void
8988 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8989 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
8990 {
8991 int i, rslt;
8992 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
8993 char *msg;
8994 struct cleanup *old_chain;
8995
8996 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
8997 {
8998 struct gdbarch *sarch;
8999
9000 sal = &sals->sals[i];
9001
9002 sarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
9003 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9004 associated with SAL. */
9005 if (sarch == NULL)
9006 sarch = gdbarch;
9007 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal->pc,
9008 NULL, &msg);
9009 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
9010
9011 if (!rslt)
9012 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
9013 paddress (sarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
9014
9015 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9016 }
9017 }
9018
9019 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9020 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9021 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9022 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9023 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9024 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9025
9026 static void
9027 find_condition_and_thread (char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9028 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9029 char **rest)
9030 {
9031 *cond_string = NULL;
9032 *thread = -1;
9033 while (tok && *tok)
9034 {
9035 char *end_tok;
9036 int toklen;
9037 char *cond_start = NULL;
9038 char *cond_end = NULL;
9039
9040 tok = skip_spaces (tok);
9041
9042 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9043 {
9044 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9045 return;
9046 }
9047
9048 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
9049
9050 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9051
9052 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9053 {
9054 struct expression *expr;
9055
9056 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9057 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9058 xfree (expr);
9059 cond_end = tok;
9060 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9061 }
9062 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9063 {
9064 char *tmptok;
9065
9066 tok = end_tok + 1;
9067 tmptok = tok;
9068 *thread = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
9069 if (tok == tmptok)
9070 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9071 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
9072 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), *thread);
9073 }
9074 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9075 {
9076 char *tmptok;
9077
9078 tok = end_tok + 1;
9079 tmptok = tok;
9080 *task = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
9081 if (tok == tmptok)
9082 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9083 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9084 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9085 }
9086 else if (rest)
9087 {
9088 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9089 return;
9090 }
9091 else
9092 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9093 }
9094 }
9095
9096 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9097
9098 static struct symtabs_and_lines
9099 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (char **arg_p)
9100 {
9101 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers = NULL;
9102 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9103 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9104 char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9105 char *endp;
9106 char *marker_str;
9107 int i;
9108
9109 p = skip_spaces (p);
9110
9111 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9112
9113 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
9114 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, marker_str);
9115
9116 markers = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str);
9117 if (VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
9118 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"), marker_str);
9119
9120 sals.nelts = VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers);
9121 sals.sals = xmalloc (sizeof *sals.sals * sals.nelts);
9122
9123 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
9124 {
9125 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
9126
9127 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, i);
9128
9129 init_sal (&sals.sals[i]);
9130
9131 sals.sals[i] = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
9132 sals.sals[i].pc = marker->address;
9133
9134 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
9135 }
9136
9137 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9138
9139 *arg_p = endp;
9140 return sals;
9141 }
9142
9143 /* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between CLI and MI
9144 functions for setting a breakpoint. This function has two major
9145 modes of operations, selected by the PARSE_CONDITION_AND_THREAD
9146 parameter. If non-zero, the function will parse arg, extracting
9147 breakpoint location, address and thread. Otherwise, ARG is just
9148 the location of breakpoint, with condition and thread specified by
9149 the COND_STRING and THREAD parameters. If INTERNAL is non-zero,
9150 the breakpoint number will be allocated from the internal
9151 breakpoint count. Returns true if any breakpoint was created;
9152 false otherwise. */
9153
9154 int
9155 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9156 char *arg, char *cond_string,
9157 int thread, char *extra_string,
9158 int parse_condition_and_thread,
9159 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9160 int ignore_count,
9161 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9162 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9163 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9164 unsigned flags)
9165 {
9166 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
9167 char *copy_arg = NULL;
9168 char *addr_start = arg;
9169 struct linespec_result canonical;
9170 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9171 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
9172 int pending = 0;
9173 int task = 0;
9174 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9175
9176 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9177
9178 init_linespec_result (&canonical);
9179
9180 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
9181 {
9182 ops->create_sals_from_address (&arg, &canonical, type_wanted,
9183 addr_start, &copy_arg);
9184 }
9185
9186 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
9187 switch (e.reason)
9188 {
9189 case GDB_NO_ERROR:
9190 if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical.sals))
9191 return 0;
9192 break;
9193 case RETURN_ERROR:
9194 switch (e.error)
9195 {
9196 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
9197
9198 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9199 error. */
9200
9201 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9202 throw_exception (e);
9203
9204 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9205
9206 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9207 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9208 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9209 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9210 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9211 return 0;
9212
9213 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9214 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9215 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9216 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9217 {
9218 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9219
9220 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
9221 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (copy_arg);
9222 lsal.sals.nelts = 1;
9223 lsal.sals.sals = XNEW (struct symtab_and_line);
9224 init_sal (&lsal.sals.sals[0]);
9225 pending = 1;
9226 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, &lsal);
9227 }
9228 break;
9229 default:
9230 throw_exception (e);
9231 }
9232 break;
9233 default:
9234 throw_exception (e);
9235 }
9236
9237 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
9238 old_chain = make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical);
9239
9240 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
9241 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
9242 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
9243 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
9244 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
9245
9246 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9247 are ok for the target. */
9248 if (!pending)
9249 {
9250 int ix;
9251 struct linespec_sals *iter;
9252
9253 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix)
9254 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&iter->sals);
9255 }
9256
9257 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9258 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9259 {
9260 int ix;
9261 struct linespec_sals *iter;
9262
9263 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix)
9264 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &iter->sals);
9265 }
9266
9267 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9268 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9269 breakpoint. */
9270 if (!pending)
9271 {
9272 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
9273
9274 lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0);
9275
9276 if (parse_condition_and_thread)
9277 {
9278 char *rest;
9279 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9280 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9281 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9282 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9283 cond_string = NULL;
9284 thread = -1;
9285 rest = NULL;
9286 find_condition_and_thread (arg, lsal->sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
9287 &thread, &task, &rest);
9288 if (cond_string)
9289 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9290 if (rest)
9291 make_cleanup (xfree, rest);
9292 if (rest)
9293 extra_string = rest;
9294 }
9295 else
9296 {
9297 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9298 if (cond_string)
9299 {
9300 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
9301 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9302 }
9303 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9304 if (extra_string)
9305 {
9306 extra_string = xstrdup (extra_string);
9307 make_cleanup (xfree, extra_string);
9308 }
9309 }
9310
9311 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical, lsal,
9312 cond_string, extra_string, type_wanted,
9313 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9314 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9315 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9316 }
9317 else
9318 {
9319 struct breakpoint *b;
9320
9321 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
9322
9323 if (is_tracepoint_type (type_wanted))
9324 {
9325 struct tracepoint *t;
9326
9327 t = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
9328 b = &t->base;
9329 }
9330 else
9331 b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
9332
9333 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9334
9335 b->addr_string = copy_arg;
9336 b->cond_string = NULL;
9337 b->extra_string = NULL;
9338 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9339 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9340 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9341 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9342 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9343 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9344 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9345
9346 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0);
9347 }
9348
9349 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 1)
9350 {
9351 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9352 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9353 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9354 }
9355
9356 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
9357 breakpoint. */
9358 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
9359 /* But cleanup everything else. */
9360 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9361
9362 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
9363 update_global_location_list (1);
9364
9365 return 1;
9366 }
9367
9368 /* Set a breakpoint.
9369 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9370 condition, and thread.
9371 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9372 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9373 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
9374
9375 static void
9376 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9377 {
9378 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9379 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9380 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9381 : bp_breakpoint);
9382 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
9383 const char *arg_cp = arg;
9384
9385 /* Matching breakpoints on probes. */
9386 if (arg && probe_linespec_to_ops (&arg_cp) != NULL)
9387 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9388 else
9389 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9390
9391 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9392 arg,
9393 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
9394 tempflag, type_wanted,
9395 0 /* Ignore count */,
9396 pending_break_support,
9397 ops,
9398 from_tty,
9399 1 /* enabled */,
9400 0 /* internal */,
9401 0);
9402 }
9403
9404 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9405
9406 void
9407 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9408 {
9409 CORE_ADDR pc;
9410
9411 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9412 {
9413 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
9414 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9415 sal->line, sal->symtab->filename);
9416 sal->pc = pc;
9417
9418 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9419 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9420 if (sal->explicit_line)
9421 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
9422 }
9423
9424 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9425 {
9426 struct blockvector *bv;
9427 struct block *b;
9428 struct symbol *sym;
9429
9430 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
9431 if (bv != NULL)
9432 {
9433 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
9434 if (sym != NULL)
9435 {
9436 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
9437 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sym);
9438 }
9439 else
9440 {
9441 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9442 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9443 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9444 happen in assembly source). */
9445
9446 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
9447 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
9448
9449 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
9450
9451 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
9452 if (msym)
9453 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym);
9454
9455 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9456 }
9457 }
9458 }
9459 }
9460
9461 void
9462 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9463 {
9464 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9465 }
9466
9467 void
9468 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9469 {
9470 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
9471 }
9472
9473 static void
9474 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9475 {
9476 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
9477 }
9478
9479 static void
9480 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9481 {
9482 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
9483 }
9484
9485 static void
9486 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9487 {
9488 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
9489 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
9490 stop at <line>\n"));
9491 }
9492
9493 static void
9494 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9495 {
9496 int badInput = 0;
9497
9498 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
9499 badInput = 1;
9500 else if (*arg != '*')
9501 {
9502 char *argptr = arg;
9503 int hasColon = 0;
9504
9505 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
9506 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
9507 function/method name. */
9508 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9509 {
9510 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9511 argptr++;
9512 }
9513
9514 if (hasColon)
9515 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
9516 else
9517 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
9518 }
9519
9520 if (badInput)
9521 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
9522 else
9523 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9524 }
9525
9526 static void
9527 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9528 {
9529 int badInput = 0;
9530
9531 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
9532 badInput = 1;
9533 else
9534 {
9535 char *argptr = arg;
9536 int hasColon = 0;
9537
9538 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
9539 it is probably a line number. */
9540 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9541 {
9542 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9543 argptr++;
9544 }
9545
9546 if (hasColon)
9547 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
9548 else
9549 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
9550 }
9551
9552 if (badInput)
9553 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
9554 else
9555 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9556 }
9557
9558 void dprintf_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
9559
9560 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
9561 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
9562 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
9563 line. */
9564
9565 void
9566 dprintf_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9567 {
9568 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9569 arg,
9570 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
9571 0, bp_dprintf,
9572 0 /* Ignore count */,
9573 pending_break_support,
9574 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
9575 from_tty,
9576 1 /* enabled */,
9577 0 /* internal */,
9578 0);
9579 }
9580
9581 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
9582 ranged breakpoints. */
9583
9584 static int
9585 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
9586 struct address_space *aspace,
9587 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
9588 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
9589 {
9590 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
9591 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
9592 return 0;
9593
9594 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
9595 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
9596 }
9597
9598 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9599 ranged breakpoints. */
9600
9601 static int
9602 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
9603 {
9604 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9605 }
9606
9607 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
9608 ranged breakpoints. */
9609
9610 static enum print_stop_action
9611 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
9612 {
9613 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
9614 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9615 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9616
9617 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9618
9619 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9620 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9621
9622 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
9623 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
9624 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary ranged breakpoint ");
9625 else
9626 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nRanged breakpoint ");
9627 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
9628 {
9629 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
9630 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
9631 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
9632 }
9633 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
9634 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
9635
9636 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
9637 }
9638
9639 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
9640 ranged breakpoints. */
9641
9642 static void
9643 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9644 struct bp_location **last_loc)
9645 {
9646 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9647 struct value_print_options opts;
9648 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9649
9650 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9651 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9652
9653 get_user_print_options (&opts);
9654
9655 if (opts.addressprint)
9656 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
9657 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
9658 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
9659 annotate_field (5);
9660 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
9661 *last_loc = bl;
9662 }
9663
9664 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
9665 ranged breakpoints. */
9666
9667 static void
9668 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
9669 struct ui_out *uiout)
9670 {
9671 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
9672 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9673 struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen ();
9674 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
9675
9676 gdb_assert (bl);
9677
9678 address_start = bl->address;
9679 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
9680
9681 ui_out_text (uiout, "\taddress range: ");
9682 fprintf_unfiltered (stb, "[%s, %s]",
9683 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
9684 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
9685 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "addr", stb);
9686 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
9687
9688 do_cleanups (cleanup);
9689 }
9690
9691 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
9692 ranged breakpoints. */
9693
9694 static void
9695 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9696 {
9697 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9698 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9699
9700 gdb_assert (bl);
9701 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9702
9703 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
9704 return;
9705
9706 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
9707 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
9708 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
9709 }
9710
9711 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
9712 ranged breakpoints. */
9713
9714 static void
9715 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
9716 {
9717 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s", b->addr_string,
9718 b->addr_string_range_end);
9719 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
9720 }
9721
9722 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
9723
9724 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
9725
9726 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
9727 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
9728 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
9729 last instruction of the given line. */
9730
9731 static CORE_ADDR
9732 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
9733 {
9734 CORE_ADDR end;
9735
9736 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
9737 find the address of the end of the given location. */
9738 if (sal.explicit_pc)
9739 end = sal.pc;
9740 else
9741 {
9742 int ret;
9743 CORE_ADDR start;
9744
9745 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
9746 if (!ret)
9747 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9748
9749 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
9750 end--;
9751 }
9752
9753 return end;
9754 }
9755
9756 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
9757
9758 static void
9759 break_range_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9760 {
9761 char *arg_start, *addr_string_start, *addr_string_end;
9762 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
9763 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
9764 CORE_ADDR end;
9765 struct breakpoint *b;
9766 struct symtab_and_line sal_start, sal_end;
9767 struct cleanup *cleanup_bkpt;
9768 struct linespec_sals *lsal_start, *lsal_end;
9769
9770 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
9771 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
9772 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
9773
9774 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9775 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9776 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9777 bp_count, 0);
9778 if (can_use_bp < 0)
9779 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9780
9781 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9782 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
9783 error(_("No address range specified."));
9784
9785 init_linespec_result (&canonical_start);
9786
9787 arg_start = arg;
9788 parse_breakpoint_sals (&arg, &canonical_start);
9789
9790 cleanup_bkpt = make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_start);
9791
9792 if (arg[0] != ',')
9793 error (_("Too few arguments."));
9794 else if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals))
9795 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
9796
9797 lsal_start = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals, 0);
9798
9799 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals) > 1
9800 || lsal_start->sals.nelts != 1)
9801 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9802
9803 sal_start = lsal_start->sals.sals[0];
9804 addr_string_start = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
9805 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string_start);
9806
9807 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
9808 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9809
9810 /* Parse the end location. */
9811
9812 init_linespec_result (&canonical_end);
9813 arg_start = arg;
9814
9815 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
9816 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
9817 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
9818 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
9819 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
9820 decode_line_full (&arg, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
9821 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
9822 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
9823
9824 make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_end);
9825
9826 if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals))
9827 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9828
9829 lsal_end = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals, 0);
9830 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals) > 1
9831 || lsal_end->sals.nelts != 1)
9832 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9833
9834 sal_end = lsal_end->sals.sals[0];
9835 addr_string_end = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
9836 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string_end);
9837
9838 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
9839 if (sal_start.pc > end)
9840 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
9841
9842 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
9843 if (length < 0)
9844 /* Length overflowed. */
9845 error (_("Address range too large."));
9846 else if (length == 1)
9847 {
9848 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
9849 the `hbreak' command. */
9850 hbreak_command (addr_string_start, 1);
9851
9852 do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt);
9853
9854 return;
9855 }
9856
9857 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
9858 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
9859 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
9860 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
9861 b->number = breakpoint_count;
9862 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
9863 b->addr_string = xstrdup (addr_string_start);
9864 b->addr_string_range_end = xstrdup (addr_string_end);
9865 b->loc->length = length;
9866
9867 do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt);
9868
9869 mention (b);
9870 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
9871 update_global_location_list (1);
9872 }
9873
9874 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
9875 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
9876 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
9877 zero. */
9878
9879 static int
9880 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
9881 {
9882 int i = exp->nelts;
9883
9884 while (i > 0)
9885 {
9886 int oplenp, argsp;
9887
9888 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
9889 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
9890 i -= oplenp;
9891
9892 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
9893 {
9894 case BINOP_ADD:
9895 case BINOP_SUB:
9896 case BINOP_MUL:
9897 case BINOP_DIV:
9898 case BINOP_REM:
9899 case BINOP_MOD:
9900 case BINOP_LSH:
9901 case BINOP_RSH:
9902 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
9903 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
9904 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
9905 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
9906 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
9907 case BINOP_EQUAL:
9908 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
9909 case BINOP_LESS:
9910 case BINOP_GTR:
9911 case BINOP_LEQ:
9912 case BINOP_GEQ:
9913 case BINOP_REPEAT:
9914 case BINOP_COMMA:
9915 case BINOP_EXP:
9916 case BINOP_MIN:
9917 case BINOP_MAX:
9918 case BINOP_INTDIV:
9919 case BINOP_CONCAT:
9920 case BINOP_IN:
9921 case BINOP_RANGE:
9922 case TERNOP_COND:
9923 case TERNOP_SLICE:
9924 case TERNOP_SLICE_COUNT:
9925
9926 case OP_LONG:
9927 case OP_DOUBLE:
9928 case OP_DECFLOAT:
9929 case OP_LAST:
9930 case OP_COMPLEX:
9931 case OP_STRING:
9932 case OP_BITSTRING:
9933 case OP_ARRAY:
9934 case OP_TYPE:
9935 case OP_NAME:
9936 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
9937
9938 case UNOP_NEG:
9939 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
9940 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
9941 case UNOP_ADDR:
9942 case UNOP_HIGH:
9943 case UNOP_CAST:
9944 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
9945 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
9946 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
9947 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
9948
9949 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
9950 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
9951 ADDR is. */
9952 break;
9953
9954 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
9955 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
9956
9957 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
9958 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
9959 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
9960 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
9961
9962 We also have to check for function symbols because they
9963 are always constant. */
9964 {
9965 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
9966
9967 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
9968 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
9969 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
9970 return 0;
9971 break;
9972 }
9973
9974 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
9975 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
9976 then it is not a constant. */
9977 default:
9978 return 0;
9979 }
9980 }
9981
9982 return 1;
9983 }
9984
9985 /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
9986
9987 static void
9988 dtor_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *self)
9989 {
9990 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) self;
9991
9992 xfree (w->cond_exp);
9993 xfree (w->exp);
9994 xfree (w->exp_string);
9995 xfree (w->exp_string_reparse);
9996 value_free (w->val);
9997
9998 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self);
9999 }
10000
10001 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10002
10003 static void
10004 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10005 {
10006 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10007
10008 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10009 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10010
10011 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10012 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10013 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10014 are loaded and unloaded.
10015
10016 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10017 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10018 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10019 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10020 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10021 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10022
10023 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10024 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10025 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10026 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10027
10028 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10029 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10030
10031 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10032 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10033 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10034 }
10035
10036 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10037
10038 static int
10039 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10040 {
10041 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10042 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10043
10044 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10045 w->cond_exp);
10046 }
10047
10048 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10049
10050 static int
10051 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10052 {
10053 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10054 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10055
10056 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10057 w->cond_exp);
10058 }
10059
10060 static int
10061 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10062 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10063 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10064 {
10065 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10066 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10067
10068 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10069 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10070 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10071 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10072 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10073 (did not match the data address). */
10074 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10075 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10076 return 0;
10077
10078 return 1;
10079 }
10080
10081 static void
10082 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10083 {
10084 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10085
10086 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10087 }
10088
10089 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10090 hardware watchpoints. */
10091
10092 static int
10093 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10094 {
10095 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10096 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10097
10098 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10099 }
10100
10101 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10102 hardware watchpoints. */
10103
10104 static int
10105 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10106 {
10107 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10108 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10109 }
10110
10111 static enum print_stop_action
10112 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10113 {
10114 struct cleanup *old_chain;
10115 struct breakpoint *b;
10116 const struct bp_location *bl;
10117 struct ui_file *stb;
10118 enum print_stop_action result;
10119 struct watchpoint *w;
10120 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10121
10122 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10123
10124 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
10125 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10126 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10127
10128 stb = mem_fileopen ();
10129 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
10130
10131 switch (b->type)
10132 {
10133 case bp_watchpoint:
10134 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10135 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10136 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10137 ui_out_field_string
10138 (uiout, "reason",
10139 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10140 mention (b);
10141 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10142 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
10143 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb);
10144 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
10145 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
10146 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10147 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
10148 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10149 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10150 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10151 break;
10152
10153 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10154 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10155 ui_out_field_string
10156 (uiout, "reason",
10157 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10158 mention (b);
10159 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10160 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
10161 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10162 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
10163 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10164 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10165 break;
10166
10167 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10168 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10169 {
10170 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10171 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10172 ui_out_field_string
10173 (uiout, "reason",
10174 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10175 mention (b);
10176 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10177 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
10178 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb);
10179 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
10180 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
10181 }
10182 else
10183 {
10184 mention (b);
10185 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10186 ui_out_field_string
10187 (uiout, "reason",
10188 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10189 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10190 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
10191 }
10192 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10193 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
10194 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10195 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10196 break;
10197 default:
10198 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10199 }
10200
10201 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10202 return result;
10203 }
10204
10205 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10206 watchpoints. */
10207
10208 static void
10209 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10210 {
10211 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
10212 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10213 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10214
10215 switch (b->type)
10216 {
10217 case bp_watchpoint:
10218 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
10219 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10220 break;
10221 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10222 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
10223 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10224 break;
10225 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10226 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
10227 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
10228 break;
10229 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10230 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10231 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
10232 break;
10233 default:
10234 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10235 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10236 }
10237
10238 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
10239 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
10240 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", w->exp_string);
10241 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
10242 }
10243
10244 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10245 watchpoints. */
10246
10247 static void
10248 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10249 {
10250 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10251
10252 switch (b->type)
10253 {
10254 case bp_watchpoint:
10255 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10256 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10257 break;
10258 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10259 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10260 break;
10261 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10262 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10263 break;
10264 default:
10265 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10266 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10267 }
10268
10269 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10270 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10271 }
10272
10273 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10274
10275 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10276
10277 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10278 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10279
10280 static int
10281 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10282 {
10283 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10284
10285 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10286 bl->watchpoint_type);
10287 }
10288
10289 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10290 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10291
10292 static int
10293 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10294 {
10295 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10296
10297 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10298 bl->watchpoint_type);
10299 }
10300
10301 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10302 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10303
10304 static int
10305 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10306 {
10307 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10308
10309 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10310 }
10311
10312 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10313 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10314
10315 static int
10316 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10317 {
10318 return 0;
10319 }
10320
10321 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10322 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10323
10324 static enum print_stop_action
10325 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10326 {
10327 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10328 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10329
10330 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10331 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10332
10333 switch (b->type)
10334 {
10335 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10336 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10337 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10338 ui_out_field_string
10339 (uiout, "reason",
10340 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10341 break;
10342
10343 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10344 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10345 ui_out_field_string
10346 (uiout, "reason",
10347 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10348 break;
10349
10350 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10351 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10352 ui_out_field_string
10353 (uiout, "reason",
10354 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10355 break;
10356 default:
10357 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10358 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10359 }
10360
10361 mention (b);
10362 ui_out_text (uiout, _("\n\
10363 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10364 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10365 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10366
10367 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10368 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10369 }
10370
10371 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10372 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10373
10374 static void
10375 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10376 struct ui_out *uiout)
10377 {
10378 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10379
10380 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10381 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10382
10383 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmask ");
10384 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
10385 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10386 }
10387
10388 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10389 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10390
10391 static void
10392 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10393 {
10394 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10395 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10396 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
10397
10398 switch (b->type)
10399 {
10400 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10401 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10402 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10403 break;
10404 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10405 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10406 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
10407 break;
10408 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10409 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10410 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
10411 break;
10412 default:
10413 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10414 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10415 }
10416
10417 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
10418 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
10419 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", w->exp_string);
10420 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
10421 }
10422
10423 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10424 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10425
10426 static void
10427 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10428 {
10429 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10430 char tmp[40];
10431
10432 switch (b->type)
10433 {
10434 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10435 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10436 break;
10437 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10438 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10439 break;
10440 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10441 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10442 break;
10443 default:
10444 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10445 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10446 }
10447
10448 sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask);
10449 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp);
10450 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10451 }
10452
10453 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10454
10455 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10456
10457 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10458
10459 static int
10460 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10461 {
10462 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10463 }
10464
10465 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10466 hw_read: watch read,
10467 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
10468 static void
10469 watch_command_1 (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
10470 int just_location, int internal)
10471 {
10472 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
10473 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
10474 struct expression *exp;
10475 struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
10476 struct value *val, *mark, *result;
10477 struct frame_info *frame;
10478 char *exp_start = NULL;
10479 char *exp_end = NULL;
10480 char *tok, *end_tok;
10481 int toklen = -1;
10482 char *cond_start = NULL;
10483 char *cond_end = NULL;
10484 enum bptype bp_type;
10485 int thread = -1;
10486 int pc = 0;
10487 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
10488 the hardware watchpoint. */
10489 int use_mask = 0;
10490 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
10491 struct watchpoint *w;
10492
10493 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
10494 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
10495 {
10496 char *value_start;
10497
10498 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
10499 of the arguments string. */
10500 for (tok = arg + strlen (arg) - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
10501 {
10502 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
10503 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10504 tok--;
10505
10506 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
10507 This is the value of the parameter. */
10508 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10509 tok--;
10510 value_start = tok + 1;
10511
10512 /* Skip whitespace. */
10513 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10514 tok--;
10515
10516 end_tok = tok;
10517
10518 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
10519 This is the parameter itself. */
10520 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10521 tok--;
10522 tok++;
10523 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
10524
10525 if (toklen == 6 && !strncmp (tok, "thread", 6))
10526 {
10527 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
10528 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
10529 only in a specific thread. */
10530 char *endp;
10531
10532 if (thread != -1)
10533 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
10534
10535 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
10536 thread = strtol (value_start, &endp, 0);
10537
10538 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
10539 thread ID. */
10540 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
10541 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), value_start);
10542
10543 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
10544 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
10545 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), thread);
10546 }
10547 else if (toklen == 4 && !strncmp (tok, "mask", 4))
10548 {
10549 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
10550 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
10551 facility. */
10552 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
10553
10554 if (use_mask)
10555 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
10556
10557 use_mask = just_location = 1;
10558
10559 mark = value_mark ();
10560 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
10561 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
10562 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10563 }
10564 else
10565 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
10566 break;
10567
10568 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
10569 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
10570 *tok = '\0';
10571 }
10572 }
10573
10574 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. */
10575 innermost_block = NULL;
10576 exp_start = arg;
10577 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
10578 exp_end = arg;
10579 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
10580 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
10581 prettier. */
10582 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
10583 --exp_end;
10584
10585 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
10586 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp))
10587 {
10588 int len;
10589
10590 len = exp_end - exp_start;
10591 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
10592 len--;
10593 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
10594 }
10595
10596 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
10597 mark = value_mark ();
10598 fetch_subexp_value (exp, &pc, &val, &result, NULL);
10599
10600 if (just_location)
10601 {
10602 int ret;
10603
10604 exp_valid_block = NULL;
10605 val = value_addr (result);
10606 release_value (val);
10607 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10608
10609 if (use_mask)
10610 {
10611 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val),
10612 mask);
10613 if (ret == -1)
10614 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
10615 else if (ret == -2)
10616 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
10617 }
10618 }
10619 else if (val != NULL)
10620 release_value (val);
10621
10622 tok = skip_spaces (arg);
10623 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
10624
10625 toklen = end_tok - tok;
10626 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
10627 {
10628 struct expression *cond;
10629
10630 innermost_block = NULL;
10631 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
10632 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0);
10633
10634 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
10635 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
10636 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
10637
10638 xfree (cond);
10639 cond_end = tok;
10640 }
10641 if (*tok)
10642 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
10643
10644 if (accessflag == hw_read)
10645 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
10646 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
10647 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
10648 else
10649 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10650
10651 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
10652
10653 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
10654 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
10655 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
10656 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
10657 if (exp_valid_block && frame)
10658 {
10659 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
10660 {
10661 scope_breakpoint
10662 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
10663 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
10664 bp_watchpoint_scope,
10665 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
10666
10667 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10668
10669 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
10670 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
10671
10672 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
10673 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
10674
10675 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
10676 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
10677 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
10678 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
10679 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
10680 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
10681 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
10682 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
10683 scope_breakpoint->type);
10684 }
10685 }
10686
10687 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
10688
10689 w = XCNEW (struct watchpoint);
10690 b = &w->base;
10691 if (use_mask)
10692 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type,
10693 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10694 else
10695 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type,
10696 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10697 b->thread = thread;
10698 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10699 b->pspace = current_program_space;
10700 w->exp = exp;
10701 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
10702 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
10703 if (just_location)
10704 {
10705 struct type *t = value_type (val);
10706 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val);
10707 char *name;
10708
10709 t = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (check_typedef (t)));
10710 name = type_to_string (t);
10711
10712 w->exp_string_reparse = xstrprintf ("* (%s *) %s", name,
10713 core_addr_to_string (addr));
10714 xfree (name);
10715
10716 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
10717 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
10718
10719 /* The above expression is in C. */
10720 b->language = language_c;
10721 }
10722 else
10723 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
10724
10725 if (use_mask)
10726 {
10727 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
10728 }
10729 else
10730 {
10731 w->val = val;
10732 w->val_valid = 1;
10733 }
10734
10735 if (cond_start)
10736 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
10737 else
10738 b->cond_string = 0;
10739
10740 if (frame)
10741 {
10742 w->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
10743 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
10744 }
10745 else
10746 {
10747 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
10748 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
10749 }
10750
10751 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
10752 {
10753 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
10754 need to act on them together. */
10755 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
10756 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
10757 }
10758
10759 if (!just_location)
10760 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10761
10762 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
10763 {
10764 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
10765 that should be inserted. */
10766 update_watchpoint (w, 1);
10767 }
10768 if (e.reason < 0)
10769 {
10770 delete_breakpoint (b);
10771 throw_exception (e);
10772 }
10773
10774 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 1);
10775 }
10776
10777 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
10778 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
10779
10780 static int
10781 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
10782 {
10783 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
10784 struct value *head = v;
10785
10786 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
10787 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
10788 return 0;
10789
10790 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
10791 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
10792 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
10793 hardware watchpoint.
10794
10795 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
10796 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
10797 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
10798 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
10799 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
10800 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
10801 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
10802 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
10803 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
10804
10805 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
10806 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
10807 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
10808 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
10809 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
10810 {
10811 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
10812 {
10813 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
10814 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
10815 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
10816 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
10817 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
10818 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
10819 ;
10820 else
10821 {
10822 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
10823 it with hardware watchpoints. */
10824 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
10825
10826 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
10827 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
10828 middle of some value chain. */
10829 if (v == head
10830 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10831 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
10832 {
10833 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
10834 int len;
10835 int num_regs;
10836
10837 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
10838 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
10839 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
10840
10841 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
10842 if (!num_regs)
10843 return 0;
10844 else
10845 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
10846 }
10847 }
10848 }
10849 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
10850 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
10851 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
10852 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
10853 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
10854 }
10855
10856 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
10857 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
10858 return found_memory_cnt;
10859 }
10860
10861 void
10862 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10863 {
10864 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
10865 }
10866
10867 /* A helper function that looks for an argument at the start of a
10868 string. The argument must also either be at the end of the string,
10869 or be followed by whitespace. Returns 1 if it finds the argument,
10870 0 otherwise. If the argument is found, it updates *STR. */
10871
10872 static int
10873 check_for_argument (char **str, char *arg, int arg_len)
10874 {
10875 if (strncmp (*str, arg, arg_len) == 0
10876 && ((*str)[arg_len] == '\0' || isspace ((*str)[arg_len])))
10877 {
10878 *str += arg_len;
10879 return 1;
10880 }
10881 return 0;
10882 }
10883
10884 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
10885 calls watch_command_1. */
10886
10887 static void
10888 watch_maybe_just_location (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
10889 {
10890 int just_location = 0;
10891
10892 if (arg
10893 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
10894 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
10895 {
10896 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10897 just_location = 1;
10898 }
10899
10900 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
10901 }
10902
10903 static void
10904 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10905 {
10906 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
10907 }
10908
10909 void
10910 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10911 {
10912 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
10913 }
10914
10915 static void
10916 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10917 {
10918 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
10919 }
10920
10921 void
10922 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10923 {
10924 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
10925 }
10926
10927 static void
10928 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10929 {
10930 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
10931 }
10932 \f
10933
10934 /* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
10935 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
10936
10937 struct until_break_command_continuation_args
10938 {
10939 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
10940 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
10941 int thread_num;
10942 };
10943
10944 /* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
10945 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
10946 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
10947 command. */
10948 static void
10949 until_break_command_continuation (void *arg, int err)
10950 {
10951 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
10952
10953 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
10954 if (a->breakpoint2)
10955 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
10956 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (a->thread_num);
10957 }
10958
10959 void
10960 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
10961 {
10962 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
10963 struct symtab_and_line sal;
10964 struct frame_info *frame;
10965 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
10966 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
10967 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
10968 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
10969 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
10970 struct cleanup *old_chain;
10971 int thread;
10972 struct thread_info *tp;
10973
10974 clear_proceed_status ();
10975
10976 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
10977 this function. */
10978
10979 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
10980 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
10981 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
10982 get_last_displayed_line ());
10983 else
10984 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
10985 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0);
10986
10987 if (sals.nelts != 1)
10988 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
10989
10990 sal = sals.sals[0];
10991 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed. */
10992
10993 if (*arg)
10994 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
10995
10996 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
10997
10998 tp = inferior_thread ();
10999 thread = tp->num;
11000
11001 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11002
11003 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11004 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11005 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11006 that. */
11007
11008 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11009 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11010 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11011 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11012
11013 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11014 one. */
11015
11016 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11017 {
11018 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11019
11020 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11021 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11022 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
11023 sal2,
11024 caller_frame_id,
11025 bp_until);
11026 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
11027
11028 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11029 make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread);
11030 }
11031
11032 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11033 frame = NULL;
11034
11035 if (anywhere)
11036 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11037 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11038 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11039 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11040 else
11041 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11042 only at the very same frame. */
11043 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11044 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11045 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
11046
11047 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
11048
11049 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has
11050 actually managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to
11051 be deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already
11052 stopped and delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
11053
11054 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
11055 {
11056 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
11057 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
11058
11059 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
11060 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
11061 args->thread_num = thread;
11062
11063 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
11064 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
11065 until_break_command_continuation, args,
11066 xfree);
11067 }
11068 else
11069 do_cleanups (old_chain);
11070 }
11071
11072 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11073 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11074
11075 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11076 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11077 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11078 if clause in the arg string. */
11079
11080 static char *
11081 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
11082 {
11083 char *cond_string;
11084
11085 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11086 return NULL;
11087
11088 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11089 (*arg) += 2;
11090
11091 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11092 condition string. */
11093 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11094 cond_string = *arg;
11095
11096 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11097 string. */
11098 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11099
11100 return cond_string;
11101 }
11102
11103 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11104 process start/exit, etc. */
11105
11106 typedef enum
11107 {
11108 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11109 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11110 }
11111 catch_fork_kind;
11112
11113 static void
11114 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11115 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11116 {
11117 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11118 char *cond_string = NULL;
11119 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11120 int tempflag;
11121
11122 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11123 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11124 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11125
11126 if (!arg)
11127 arg = "";
11128 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11129
11130 /* The allowed syntax is:
11131 catch [v]fork
11132 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11133
11134 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11135 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11136
11137 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11138 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11139
11140 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11141 and enable reporting of such events. */
11142 switch (fork_kind)
11143 {
11144 case catch_fork_temporary:
11145 case catch_fork_permanent:
11146 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11147 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11148 break;
11149 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11150 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11151 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11152 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11153 break;
11154 default:
11155 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11156 break;
11157 }
11158 }
11159
11160 static void
11161 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11162 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11163 {
11164 struct exec_catchpoint *c;
11165 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11166 int tempflag;
11167 char *cond_string = NULL;
11168
11169 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11170
11171 if (!arg)
11172 arg = "";
11173 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11174
11175 /* The allowed syntax is:
11176 catch exec
11177 catch exec if <cond>
11178
11179 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11180 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11181
11182 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11183 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11184
11185 c = XNEW (struct exec_catchpoint);
11186 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11187 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11188 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11189
11190 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
11191 }
11192
11193 static enum print_stop_action
11194 print_it_exception_catchpoint (bpstat bs)
11195 {
11196 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11197 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
11198 int bp_temp, bp_throw;
11199
11200 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
11201
11202 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
11203 if (b->loc->address != b->loc->requested_address)
11204 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (b->loc->requested_address,
11205 b->loc->address,
11206 b->number, 1);
11207 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
11208 ui_out_text (uiout,
11209 bp_temp ? "Temporary catchpoint "
11210 : "Catchpoint ");
11211 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11212 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
11213 ui_out_text (uiout,
11214 bp_throw ? " (exception thrown), "
11215 : " (exception caught), ");
11216 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11217 {
11218 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
11219 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
11220 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
11221 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
11222 }
11223 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
11224 }
11225
11226 static void
11227 print_one_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11228 struct bp_location **last_loc)
11229 {
11230 struct value_print_options opts;
11231 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11232
11233 get_user_print_options (&opts);
11234 if (opts.addressprint)
11235 {
11236 annotate_field (4);
11237 if (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->shlib_disabled)
11238 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
11239 else
11240 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
11241 b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
11242 }
11243 annotate_field (5);
11244 if (b->loc)
11245 *last_loc = b->loc;
11246 if (strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL)
11247 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception throw");
11248 else
11249 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception catch");
11250 }
11251
11252 static void
11253 print_mention_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
11254 {
11255 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11256 int bp_temp;
11257 int bp_throw;
11258
11259 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
11260 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
11261 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_temp ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
11262 : _("Catchpoint "));
11263 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
11264 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_throw ? _(" (throw)")
11265 : _(" (catch)"));
11266 }
11267
11268 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for throw and
11269 catch catchpoints. */
11270
11271 static void
11272 print_recreate_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11273 struct ui_file *fp)
11274 {
11275 int bp_temp;
11276 int bp_throw;
11277
11278 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
11279 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
11280 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, bp_temp ? "tcatch " : "catch ");
11281 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, bp_throw ? "throw" : "catch");
11282 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
11283 }
11284
11285 static struct breakpoint_ops gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops;
11286
11287 static int
11288 handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (int tempflag, char *cond_string,
11289 enum exception_event_kind ex_event, int from_tty)
11290 {
11291 char *trigger_func_name;
11292
11293 if (ex_event == EX_EVENT_CATCH)
11294 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_begin_catch";
11295 else
11296 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_throw";
11297
11298 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
11299 trigger_func_name, cond_string, -1, NULL,
11300 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
11301 tempflag, bp_breakpoint,
11302 0,
11303 AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE /* pending */,
11304 &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops, from_tty,
11305 1 /* enabled */,
11306 0 /* internal */,
11307 0);
11308
11309 return 1;
11310 }
11311
11312 /* Deal with "catch catch" and "catch throw" commands. */
11313
11314 static void
11315 catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event, char *arg,
11316 int tempflag, int from_tty)
11317 {
11318 char *cond_string = NULL;
11319
11320 if (!arg)
11321 arg = "";
11322 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11323
11324 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11325
11326 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11327 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11328
11329 if (ex_event != EX_EVENT_THROW
11330 && ex_event != EX_EVENT_CATCH)
11331 error (_("Unsupported or unknown exception event; cannot catch it"));
11332
11333 if (handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (tempflag, cond_string, ex_event, from_tty))
11334 return;
11335
11336 warning (_("Unsupported with this platform/compiler combination."));
11337 }
11338
11339 /* Implementation of "catch catch" command. */
11340
11341 static void
11342 catch_catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
11343 {
11344 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11345
11346 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_CATCH, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
11347 }
11348
11349 /* Implementation of "catch throw" command. */
11350
11351 static void
11352 catch_throw_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
11353 {
11354 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11355
11356 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_THROW, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
11357 }
11358
11359 void
11360 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11361 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11362 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11363 char *addr_string,
11364 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11365 int tempflag,
11366 int from_tty)
11367 {
11368 if (from_tty)
11369 {
11370 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11371 if (!loc_gdbarch)
11372 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11373
11374 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11375 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11376 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11377 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11378 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11379 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11380 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11381 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11382 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11383 enough for now, though. */
11384 }
11385
11386 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops);
11387
11388 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
11389 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11390 b->addr_string = addr_string;
11391 b->language = language_ada;
11392 }
11393
11394 /* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
11395 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
11396 static VEC(int) *
11397 catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
11398 {
11399 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
11400 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (int), &result);
11401
11402 while (*arg != '\0')
11403 {
11404 int i, syscall_number;
11405 char *endptr;
11406 char cur_name[128];
11407 struct syscall s;
11408
11409 /* Skip whitespace. */
11410 while (isspace (*arg))
11411 arg++;
11412
11413 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
11414 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
11415 cur_name[i] = '\0';
11416 arg += i;
11417
11418 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
11419 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
11420 if (*endptr == '\0')
11421 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
11422 else
11423 {
11424 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
11425 to a number. */
11426 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
11427
11428 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
11429 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning,
11430 because GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no
11431 syscall number to be caught. */
11432 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
11433 }
11434
11435 /* Ok, it's valid. */
11436 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
11437 }
11438
11439 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
11440 return result;
11441 }
11442
11443 /* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
11444
11445 static void
11446 catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11447 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11448 {
11449 int tempflag;
11450 VEC(int) *filter;
11451 struct syscall s;
11452 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11453
11454 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
11455 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
11456 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
11457 this architecture yet."));
11458
11459 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11460
11461 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11462
11463 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
11464 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
11465 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
11466 for his/her architecture. */
11467 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
11468
11469 /* The allowed syntax is:
11470 catch syscall
11471 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
11472
11473 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
11474
11475 if (arg != NULL)
11476 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
11477 else
11478 filter = NULL;
11479
11480 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
11481 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
11482 }
11483
11484 static void
11485 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11486 {
11487 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11488 }
11489 \f
11490
11491 static void
11492 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11493 {
11494 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11495 }
11496
11497 /* A qsort comparison function that sorts breakpoints in order. */
11498
11499 static int
11500 compare_breakpoints (const void *a, const void *b)
11501 {
11502 const breakpoint_p *ba = a;
11503 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) *ba;
11504 const breakpoint_p *bb = b;
11505 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) *bb;
11506
11507 if ((*ba)->number < (*bb)->number)
11508 return -1;
11509 else if ((*ba)->number > (*bb)->number)
11510 return 1;
11511
11512 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
11513 the number 0. */
11514 if (ua < ub)
11515 return -1;
11516 return ub > ub ? 1 : 0;
11517 }
11518
11519 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
11520
11521 static void
11522 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11523 {
11524 struct breakpoint *b, *prev;
11525 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
11526 int ix;
11527 int default_match;
11528 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
11529 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11530 int i;
11531 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11532
11533 if (arg)
11534 {
11535 sals = decode_line_spec (arg, (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
11536 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
11537 default_match = 0;
11538 }
11539 else
11540 {
11541 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
11542 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
11543 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
11544 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
11545
11546 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
11547 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
11548 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
11549 get_last_displayed_sal (&sal);
11550 if (sal.symtab == 0)
11551 error (_("No source file specified."));
11552
11553 sals.sals[0] = sal;
11554 sals.nelts = 1;
11555
11556 default_match = 1;
11557 }
11558
11559 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
11560 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
11561 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
11562 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
11563
11564 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
11565 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
11566 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
11567 due to optimization, all in one block.
11568
11569 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
11570 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
11571 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
11572 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
11573 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
11574 to support that. */
11575
11576 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
11577 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
11578 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
11579 breakpoint. */
11580
11581 found = NULL;
11582 make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (breakpoint_p), &found);
11583 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
11584 {
11585 int is_abs, sal_name_len;
11586
11587 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
11588 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
11589 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
11590 or at default pc.
11591
11592 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
11593
11594 0 1 pc
11595 1 1 pc _and_ line
11596 0 0 line
11597 1 0 <can't happen> */
11598
11599 sal = sals.sals[i];
11600 is_abs = sal.symtab == NULL ? 1 : IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (sal.symtab->filename);
11601 sal_name_len = is_abs ? 0 : strlen (sal.symtab->filename);
11602
11603 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
11604 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11605 {
11606 int match = 0;
11607 /* Are we going to delete b? */
11608 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
11609 {
11610 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
11611 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
11612 {
11613 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
11614 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
11615 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
11616 && sal.pc
11617 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
11618 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
11619 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
11620 || loc->section == sal.section));
11621 int line_match = 0;
11622
11623 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
11624 && loc->source_file != NULL
11625 && sal.symtab != NULL
11626 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
11627 && loc->line_number == sal.line)
11628 {
11629 if (filename_cmp (loc->source_file,
11630 sal.symtab->filename) == 0)
11631 line_match = 1;
11632 else if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (sal.symtab->filename)
11633 && compare_filenames_for_search (loc->source_file,
11634 sal.symtab->filename,
11635 sal_name_len))
11636 line_match = 1;
11637 }
11638
11639 if (pc_match || line_match)
11640 {
11641 match = 1;
11642 break;
11643 }
11644 }
11645 }
11646
11647 if (match)
11648 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
11649 }
11650 }
11651
11652 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
11653 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
11654 {
11655 if (arg)
11656 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
11657 else
11658 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
11659 }
11660
11661 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
11662 qsort (VEC_address (breakpoint_p, found),
11663 VEC_length (breakpoint_p, found),
11664 sizeof (breakpoint_p),
11665 compare_breakpoints);
11666 prev = VEC_index (breakpoint_p, found, 0);
11667 for (ix = 1; VEC_iterate (breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ++ix)
11668 {
11669 if (b == prev)
11670 {
11671 VEC_ordered_remove (breakpoint_p, found, ix);
11672 --ix;
11673 }
11674 }
11675
11676 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
11677 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
11678 if (from_tty)
11679 {
11680 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
11681 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
11682 else
11683 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
11684 }
11685 breakpoints_changed ();
11686
11687 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
11688 {
11689 if (from_tty)
11690 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
11691 delete_breakpoint (b);
11692 }
11693 if (from_tty)
11694 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
11695
11696 do_cleanups (cleanups);
11697 }
11698 \f
11699 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
11700 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
11701 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
11702
11703 void
11704 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
11705 {
11706 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
11707
11708 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
11709 if (bs->breakpoint_at
11710 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
11711 && bs->stop)
11712 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
11713
11714 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
11715 {
11716 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
11717 delete_breakpoint (b);
11718 }
11719 }
11720
11721 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
11722 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
11723 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
11724 secondarily by ordering first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and
11725 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
11726 qsort being an unstable algorithm. */
11727
11728 static int
11729 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
11730 {
11731 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
11732 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
11733 /* A and B come from existing breakpoints having non-NULL OWNER. */
11734 int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
11735 int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
11736
11737 if (a->address != b->address)
11738 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
11739
11740 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
11741 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
11742 grouped. */
11743
11744 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
11745 return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num)
11746 - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num));
11747
11748 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
11749 if (a_perm != b_perm)
11750 return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
11751
11752 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
11753 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
11754 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
11755
11756 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
11757 return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
11758 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number));
11759
11760 return (a > b) - (a < b);
11761 }
11762
11763 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
11764 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
11765 content of the bp_location array. */
11766
11767 static void
11768 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
11769 {
11770 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
11771
11772 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
11773 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
11774
11775 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
11776 {
11777 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
11778
11779 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
11780 continue;
11781
11782 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
11783 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
11784
11785 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
11786 addr = bl->address - start;
11787 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
11788 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
11789
11790 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
11791
11792 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
11793 addr = end - bl->address;
11794 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
11795 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
11796 }
11797 }
11798
11799 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
11800
11801 static void
11802 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
11803 {
11804 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
11805 struct cleanup *old_chain;
11806
11807 if (!target_can_download_tracepoint ())
11808 return;
11809
11810 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
11811
11812 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
11813 {
11814 struct tracepoint *t;
11815
11816 if (!is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
11817 continue;
11818
11819 if ((bl->owner->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
11820 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
11821 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
11822 continue;
11823
11824 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
11825 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
11826 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
11827 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
11828 continue;
11829
11830 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
11831
11832 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
11833
11834 bl->inserted = 1;
11835 t = (struct tracepoint *) bl->owner;
11836 t->number_on_target = bl->owner->number;
11837 }
11838
11839 do_cleanups (old_chain);
11840 }
11841
11842 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
11843
11844 static void
11845 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
11846 {
11847 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
11848 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
11849 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
11850 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
11851
11852 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
11853 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
11854 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
11855 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
11856 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
11857
11858 left->inserted = right->inserted;
11859 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
11860 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
11861 left->target_info = right->target_info;
11862 right->inserted = left_inserted;
11863 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
11864 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
11865 right->target_info = left_target_info;
11866 }
11867
11868 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
11869 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
11870 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
11871 the target. */
11872
11873 static void
11874 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
11875 {
11876 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
11877 struct bp_location *loc;
11878 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
11879 int pspace_num;
11880
11881 address = bl->address;
11882 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
11883
11884 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
11885 evaluating conditions and if the user has
11886 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
11887 side. */
11888 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
11889 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
11890 return;
11891
11892 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
11893 the same program space as the location
11894 as "its condition has changed". We need to
11895 update the conditions on the target's side. */
11896 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
11897 {
11898 loc = *loc2p;
11899
11900 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
11901 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
11902 continue;
11903
11904 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
11905 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
11906 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
11907 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
11908 that have already been marked. */
11909 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
11910
11911 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
11912 it later on. */
11913 if (loc->cond_bytecode)
11914 {
11915 free_agent_expr (loc->cond_bytecode);
11916 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
11917 }
11918 }
11919 }
11920
11921 /* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
11922 into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
11923 longer should be inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or
11924 breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
11925 doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
11926 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
11927 returns true on them.
11928
11929 This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
11930 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
11931 shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
11932 to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
11933 execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
11934 breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior. */
11935
11936 static void
11937 update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
11938 {
11939 struct breakpoint *b;
11940 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
11941 struct cleanup *cleanups;
11942 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
11943 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
11944 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
11945 int last_pspace_num = -1;
11946
11947 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
11948 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
11949 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
11950 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
11951 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
11952 once. */
11953 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
11954 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
11955 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
11956 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
11957
11958 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly
11959 built bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
11960 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
11961 unsigned old_location_count;
11962
11963 old_location = bp_location;
11964 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
11965 bp_location = NULL;
11966 bp_location_count = 0;
11967 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
11968
11969 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11970 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11971 bp_location_count++;
11972
11973 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
11974 locp = bp_location;
11975 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11976 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11977 *locp++ = loc;
11978 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
11979 bp_location_compare);
11980
11981 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
11982
11983 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
11984 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
11985 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
11986 if there's another location at the same address (previously
11987 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
11988 location.
11989
11990 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
11991 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
11992
11993 locp = bp_location;
11994 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
11995 old_locp++)
11996 {
11997 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
11998 struct bp_location **loc2p;
11999
12000 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
12001 not, we have to free it. */
12002 int found_object = 0;
12003 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
12004 int keep_in_target = 0;
12005 int removed = 0;
12006
12007 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
12008 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
12009 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
12010 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
12011 locp++;
12012
12013 for (loc2p = locp;
12014 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
12015 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12016 loc2p++)
12017 {
12018 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
12019 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
12020 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
12021 place there. */
12022 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
12023 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
12024 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
12025 {
12026 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
12027 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
12028 }
12029
12030 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
12031 found_object = 1;
12032 }
12033
12034 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
12035 have to go through updates again. */
12036 last_addr = old_loc->address;
12037
12038 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
12039 if (!found_object)
12040 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
12041
12042 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
12043 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
12044 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
12045 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
12046 at certain location is not inserted. */
12047
12048 if (old_loc->inserted)
12049 {
12050 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
12051 it. */
12052
12053 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
12054 {
12055 /* The location is still present in the location list,
12056 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
12057 keep_in_target = 1;
12058 }
12059 else
12060 {
12061 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
12062 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
12063 remove its target-side condition. */
12064
12065 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
12066 disabled. See if there's another location at the
12067 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
12068 this one from the target. */
12069
12070 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
12071 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
12072 {
12073 for (loc2p = locp;
12074 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
12075 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12076 loc2p++)
12077 {
12078 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
12079
12080 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
12081 {
12082 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
12083 access watchpoints, if the former are not
12084 supported, but the latter are. */
12085 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
12086 {
12087 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
12088 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
12089 }
12090
12091 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
12092 if it should be inserted in case it will be
12093 unduplicated. */
12094 if (loc2 != old_loc
12095 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
12096 {
12097 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
12098 keep_in_target = 1;
12099 break;
12100 }
12101 }
12102 }
12103 }
12104 }
12105
12106 if (!keep_in_target)
12107 {
12108 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
12109 {
12110 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
12111 this location on the global list, and try to
12112 remove it next time, but there's no particular
12113 reason why we will succeed next time.
12114
12115 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
12116 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
12117 only after calling us. */
12118 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
12119 "breakpoint %d\n"),
12120 old_loc->owner->number);
12121 }
12122 removed = 1;
12123 }
12124 }
12125
12126 if (!found_object)
12127 {
12128 if (removed && non_stop
12129 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
12130 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
12131 {
12132 /* This location was removed from the target. In
12133 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
12134 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
12135 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
12136 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
12137 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
12138 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
12139 after we see some number of events. The theory here
12140 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
12141 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
12142 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
12143 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
12144 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
12145 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
12146 SIGTRAP.
12147
12148 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
12149 decr_pc_after_break targets.
12150
12151 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
12152 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
12153 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
12154 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
12155 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
12156 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
12157 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
12158 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
12159 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
12160 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
12161 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
12162 targets that do not support new thread events, like
12163 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
12164 thread_count.
12165
12166 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
12167 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
12168 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
12169 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
12170
12171 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
12172 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
12173 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
12174 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
12175 traps we can no longer explain. */
12176
12177 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
12178 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12179
12180 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
12181 }
12182 else
12183 {
12184 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12185 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
12186 }
12187 }
12188 }
12189
12190 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
12191 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
12192 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
12193 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
12194 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
12195 are sorted first for the same address.
12196
12197 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
12198 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
12199
12200 bp_loc_first = NULL;
12201 wp_loc_first = NULL;
12202 awp_loc_first = NULL;
12203 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
12204 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
12205 {
12206 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
12207 non-NULL. */
12208 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
12209 b = loc->owner;
12210
12211 if (!should_be_inserted (loc)
12212 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
12213 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
12214 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
12215 `struct bp_location'. */
12216 || is_tracepoint (b))
12217 {
12218 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12219 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12220 continue;
12221 }
12222
12223 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
12224 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
12225 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12226 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
12227 "actually inserted"));
12228
12229 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
12230 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
12231 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
12232 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
12233 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
12234 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
12235 else
12236 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
12237
12238 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
12239 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
12240 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
12241 {
12242 *loc_first_p = loc;
12243 loc->duplicate = 0;
12244
12245 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
12246 {
12247 loc->needs_update = 1;
12248 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12249 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12250 }
12251 continue;
12252 }
12253
12254
12255 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12256 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12257 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12258 if (loc->inserted)
12259 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12260 loc->duplicate = 1;
12261
12262 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12263 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12264
12265 if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
12266 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
12267 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12268 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
12269 "a permanent breakpoint"));
12270 }
12271
12272 if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ()
12273 && (have_live_inferiors ()
12274 || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))))
12275 {
12276 if (should_insert)
12277 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12278 else
12279 {
12280 /* Though should_insert is false, we may need to update conditions
12281 on the target's side if it is evaluating such conditions. We
12282 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12283 "needs_update". */
12284 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12285 }
12286 }
12287
12288 if (should_insert)
12289 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12290
12291 do_cleanups (cleanups);
12292 }
12293
12294 void
12295 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12296 {
12297 struct bp_location *loc;
12298 int ix;
12299
12300 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
12301 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12302 {
12303 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12304 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
12305 --ix;
12306 }
12307 }
12308
12309 static void
12310 update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
12311 {
12312 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
12313
12314 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
12315 update_global_location_list (inserting);
12316 }
12317
12318 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12319
12320 static void
12321 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12322 {
12323 bpstat bs;
12324
12325 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12326 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12327 {
12328 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12329 bs->old_val = NULL;
12330 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12331 }
12332 }
12333
12334 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12335 static int
12336 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12337 {
12338 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
12339
12340 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12341 return 0;
12342 }
12343
12344 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12345 callbacks. */
12346
12347 static void
12348 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12349 {
12350 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12351 struct value_print_options opts;
12352
12353 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12354
12355 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12356 single string. */
12357 if (b->loc == NULL)
12358 {
12359 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
12360 }
12361 else
12362 {
12363 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->source_file == NULL)
12364 {
12365 printf_filtered (" at ");
12366 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
12367 gdb_stdout);
12368 }
12369 if (b->loc->source_file)
12370 {
12371 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12372 more nicely. */
12373 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12374 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
12375 b->loc->source_file, b->loc->line_number);
12376 else
12377 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12378 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12379 real situation somewhat. */
12380 printf_filtered (": %s.", b->addr_string);
12381 }
12382
12383 if (b->loc->next)
12384 {
12385 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12386 int n = 0;
12387 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12388 ++n;
12389 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12390 }
12391 }
12392 }
12393
12394 /* Default bp_location_ops methods. */
12395
12396 static void
12397 bp_location_dtor (struct bp_location *self)
12398 {
12399 xfree (self->cond);
12400 if (self->cond_bytecode)
12401 free_agent_expr (self->cond_bytecode);
12402 xfree (self->function_name);
12403 xfree (self->source_file);
12404 }
12405
12406 static const struct bp_location_ops bp_location_ops =
12407 {
12408 bp_location_dtor
12409 };
12410
12411 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods all breakpoint_ops ultimately
12412 inherit from. */
12413
12414 static void
12415 base_breakpoint_dtor (struct breakpoint *self)
12416 {
12417 decref_counted_command_line (&self->commands);
12418 xfree (self->cond_string);
12419 xfree (self->addr_string);
12420 xfree (self->filter);
12421 xfree (self->addr_string_range_end);
12422 }
12423
12424 static struct bp_location *
12425 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12426 {
12427 struct bp_location *loc;
12428
12429 loc = XNEW (struct bp_location);
12430 init_bp_location (loc, &bp_location_ops, self);
12431 return loc;
12432 }
12433
12434 static void
12435 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12436 {
12437 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12438 }
12439
12440 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12441 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12442
12443 static int
12444 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12445 {
12446 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12447 }
12448
12449 static int
12450 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12451 {
12452 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12453 }
12454
12455 static int
12456 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12457 struct address_space *aspace,
12458 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12459 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12460 {
12461 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12462 }
12463
12464 static void
12465 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12466 {
12467 /* Always stop. */
12468 }
12469
12470 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12471 errors. */
12472
12473 static int
12474 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12475 {
12476 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12477 }
12478
12479 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12480 errors. */
12481
12482 static int
12483 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12484 {
12485 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12486 }
12487
12488 static enum print_stop_action
12489 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
12490 {
12491 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12492 }
12493
12494 static void
12495 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12496 struct ui_out *uiout)
12497 {
12498 /* nothing */
12499 }
12500
12501 static void
12502 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12503 {
12504 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12505 }
12506
12507 static void
12508 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12509 {
12510 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12511 }
12512
12513 static void
12514 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
12515 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12516 enum bptype type_wanted,
12517 char *addr_start,
12518 char **copy_arg)
12519 {
12520 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12521 }
12522
12523 static void
12524 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12525 struct linespec_result *c,
12526 struct linespec_sals *lsal,
12527 char *cond_string,
12528 char *extra_string,
12529 enum bptype type_wanted,
12530 enum bpdisp disposition,
12531 int thread,
12532 int task, int ignore_count,
12533 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
12534 int from_tty, int enabled,
12535 int internal, unsigned flags)
12536 {
12537 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12538 }
12539
12540 static void
12541 base_breakpoint_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
12542 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
12543 {
12544 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12545 }
12546
12547 static struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
12548 {
12549 base_breakpoint_dtor,
12550 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
12551 base_breakpoint_re_set,
12552 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
12553 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
12554 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
12555 base_breakpoint_check_status,
12556 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
12557 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
12558 base_breakpoint_print_it,
12559 NULL,
12560 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
12561 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
12562 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
12563 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_address,
12564 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
12565 base_breakpoint_decode_linespec,
12566 };
12567
12568 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
12569
12570 static void
12571 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12572 {
12573 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
12574 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
12575 {
12576 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
12577 delete_breakpoint (b);
12578 return;
12579 }
12580
12581 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12582 }
12583
12584 static int
12585 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12586 {
12587 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12588 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
12589 &bl->target_info);
12590 else
12591 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
12592 &bl->target_info);
12593 }
12594
12595 static int
12596 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12597 {
12598 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12599 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12600 else
12601 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12602 }
12603
12604 static int
12605 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12606 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12607 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12608 {
12609 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
12610
12611 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
12612 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
12613 return 0;
12614
12615 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
12616 aspace, bp_addr))
12617 return 0;
12618
12619 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
12620 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
12621 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
12622 return 0;
12623
12624 return 1;
12625 }
12626
12627 static int
12628 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12629 {
12630 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
12631
12632 return 1;
12633 }
12634
12635 static enum print_stop_action
12636 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12637 {
12638 struct breakpoint *b;
12639 const struct bp_location *bl;
12640 int bp_temp;
12641 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12642
12643 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
12644
12645 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
12646 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12647
12648 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
12649 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
12650 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
12651 bl->address,
12652 b->number, 1);
12653 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
12654 if (bp_temp)
12655 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
12656 else
12657 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
12658 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
12659 {
12660 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
12661 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12662 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12663 }
12664 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
12665 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
12666
12667 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12668 }
12669
12670 static void
12671 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12672 {
12673 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
12674 return;
12675
12676 switch (b->type)
12677 {
12678 case bp_breakpoint:
12679 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
12680 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
12681 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
12682 else
12683 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
12684 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12685 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
12686 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
12687 break;
12688 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
12689 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
12690 break;
12691 case bp_dprintf:
12692 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
12693 break;
12694 }
12695
12696 say_where (b);
12697 }
12698
12699 static void
12700 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12701 {
12702 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12703 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
12704 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
12705 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
12706 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
12707 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12708 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
12709 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
12710 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
12711 else
12712 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12713 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
12714
12715 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->addr_string);
12716 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12717 }
12718
12719 static void
12720 bkpt_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
12721 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12722 enum bptype type_wanted,
12723 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
12724 {
12725 create_sals_from_address_default (arg, canonical, type_wanted,
12726 addr_start, copy_arg);
12727 }
12728
12729 static void
12730 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12731 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12732 struct linespec_sals *lsal,
12733 char *cond_string,
12734 char *extra_string,
12735 enum bptype type_wanted,
12736 enum bpdisp disposition,
12737 int thread,
12738 int task, int ignore_count,
12739 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12740 int from_tty, int enabled,
12741 int internal, unsigned flags)
12742 {
12743 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical, lsal,
12744 cond_string, extra_string,
12745 type_wanted,
12746 disposition, thread, task,
12747 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12748 enabled, internal, flags);
12749 }
12750
12751 static void
12752 bkpt_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
12753 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
12754 {
12755 decode_linespec_default (b, s, sals);
12756 }
12757
12758 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
12759
12760 static void
12761 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12762 {
12763 switch (b->type)
12764 {
12765 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
12766 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
12767 case bp_overlay_event:
12768 case bp_longjmp_master:
12769 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12770 case bp_exception_master:
12771 delete_breakpoint (b);
12772 break;
12773
12774 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
12775 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
12776 case bp_shlib_event:
12777
12778 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
12779 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
12780 case bp_thread_event:
12781 break;
12782 }
12783 }
12784
12785 static void
12786 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12787 {
12788 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
12789 {
12790 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
12791 events. This allows the user to get control and place
12792 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
12793 objects (among other things). */
12794 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
12795 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
12796 }
12797 else
12798 bs->stop = 0;
12799 }
12800
12801 static enum print_stop_action
12802 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12803 {
12804 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12805 struct breakpoint *b;
12806
12807 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12808
12809 switch (b->type)
12810 {
12811 case bp_shlib_event:
12812 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
12813 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
12814 to shlib event" message.) */
12815 print_solib_event (0);
12816 break;
12817
12818 case bp_thread_event:
12819 /* Not sure how we will get here.
12820 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
12821 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12822 break;
12823
12824 case bp_overlay_event:
12825 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
12826 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12827 break;
12828
12829 case bp_longjmp_master:
12830 /* These should never be enabled. */
12831 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12832 break;
12833
12834 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12835 /* These should never be enabled. */
12836 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
12837 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12838 break;
12839
12840 case bp_exception_master:
12841 /* These should never be enabled. */
12842 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
12843 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12844 break;
12845 }
12846
12847 return PRINT_NOTHING;
12848 }
12849
12850 static void
12851 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12852 {
12853 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12854 }
12855
12856 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
12857
12858 static void
12859 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12860 {
12861 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
12862 over a dlopen call and SOLIB_ADD is resetting the breakpoints.
12863 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
12864 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
12865 }
12866
12867 static void
12868 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12869 {
12870 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
12871 }
12872
12873 static enum print_stop_action
12874 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12875 {
12876 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12877
12878 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
12879 {
12880 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12881
12882 switch (b->type)
12883 {
12884 case bp_finish:
12885 ui_out_field_string
12886 (uiout, "reason",
12887 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
12888 break;
12889
12890 case bp_until:
12891 ui_out_field_string
12892 (uiout, "reason",
12893 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
12894 break;
12895 }
12896 }
12897
12898 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
12899 }
12900
12901 static void
12902 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12903 {
12904 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12905 }
12906
12907 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
12908
12909 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
12910 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
12911
12912 static void
12913 longjmp_bkpt_dtor (struct breakpoint *self)
12914 {
12915 struct thread_info *tp = find_thread_id (self->thread);
12916
12917 if (tp)
12918 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
12919
12920 momentary_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self);
12921 }
12922
12923 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
12924
12925 static int
12926 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12927 {
12928 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
12929
12930 if (v == 0)
12931 {
12932 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
12933 if needed. */
12934 bl->probe->pops->set_semaphore (bl->probe, bl->gdbarch);
12935 }
12936
12937 return v;
12938 }
12939
12940 static int
12941 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12942 {
12943 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
12944 bl->probe->pops->clear_semaphore (bl->probe, bl->gdbarch);
12945
12946 return bkpt_remove_location (bl);
12947 }
12948
12949 static void
12950 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
12951 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12952 enum bptype type_wanted,
12953 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
12954 {
12955 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12956
12957 lsal.sals = parse_probes (arg, canonical);
12958
12959 *copy_arg = xstrdup (canonical->addr_string);
12960 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (*copy_arg);
12961
12962 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
12963 }
12964
12965 static void
12966 bkpt_probe_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
12967 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
12968 {
12969 *sals = parse_probes (s, NULL);
12970 if (!sals->sals)
12971 error (_("probe not found"));
12972 }
12973
12974 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
12975
12976 static void
12977 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12978 {
12979 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12980 }
12981
12982 static int
12983 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12984 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12985 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12986 {
12987 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
12988 tracepoints. */
12989 return 0;
12990 }
12991
12992 static void
12993 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12994 struct ui_out *uiout)
12995 {
12996 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12997 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id)
12998 {
12999 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
13000
13001 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmarker id is ");
13002 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
13003 tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13004 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
13005 }
13006 }
13007
13008 static void
13009 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13010 {
13011 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
13012 return;
13013
13014 switch (b->type)
13015 {
13016 case bp_tracepoint:
13017 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
13018 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13019 break;
13020 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
13021 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
13022 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13023 break;
13024 case bp_static_tracepoint:
13025 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
13026 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13027 break;
13028 default:
13029 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13030 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
13031 }
13032
13033 say_where (b);
13034 }
13035
13036 static void
13037 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
13038 {
13039 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
13040
13041 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
13042 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
13043 if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
13044 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
13045 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
13046 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
13047 else
13048 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13049 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
13050
13051 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->addr_string);
13052 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
13053
13054 if (tp->pass_count)
13055 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
13056 }
13057
13058 static void
13059 tracepoint_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13060 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13061 enum bptype type_wanted,
13062 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
13063 {
13064 create_sals_from_address_default (arg, canonical, type_wanted,
13065 addr_start, copy_arg);
13066 }
13067
13068 static void
13069 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13070 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13071 struct linespec_sals *lsal,
13072 char *cond_string,
13073 char *extra_string,
13074 enum bptype type_wanted,
13075 enum bpdisp disposition,
13076 int thread,
13077 int task, int ignore_count,
13078 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13079 int from_tty, int enabled,
13080 int internal, unsigned flags)
13081 {
13082 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical, lsal,
13083 cond_string, extra_string,
13084 type_wanted,
13085 disposition, thread, task,
13086 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13087 enabled, internal, flags);
13088 }
13089
13090 static void
13091 tracepoint_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13092 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13093 {
13094 decode_linespec_default (b, s, sals);
13095 }
13096
13097 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
13098
13099 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a
13100 static probe. */
13101
13102 static void
13103 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13104 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13105 enum bptype type_wanted,
13106 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
13107 {
13108 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13109 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_address (arg, canonical, type_wanted,
13110 addr_start, copy_arg);
13111 }
13112
13113 static void
13114 tracepoint_probe_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13115 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13116 {
13117 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13118 bkpt_probe_decode_linespec (b, s, sals);
13119 }
13120
13121 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
13122
13123 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
13124 markers (`-m'). */
13125
13126 static void
13127 strace_marker_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13128 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13129 enum bptype type_wanted,
13130 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
13131 {
13132 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13133
13134 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (arg);
13135
13136 *copy_arg = savestring (addr_start, *arg - addr_start);
13137
13138 canonical->addr_string = xstrdup (*copy_arg);
13139 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (*copy_arg);
13140 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
13141 }
13142
13143 static void
13144 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13145 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13146 struct linespec_sals *lsal,
13147 char *cond_string,
13148 char *extra_string,
13149 enum bptype type_wanted,
13150 enum bpdisp disposition,
13151 int thread,
13152 int task, int ignore_count,
13153 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13154 int from_tty, int enabled,
13155 int internal, unsigned flags)
13156 {
13157 int i;
13158
13159 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13160 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13161 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13162 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13163 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13164 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13165
13166 for (i = 0; i < lsal->sals.nelts; ++i)
13167 {
13168 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
13169 struct tracepoint *tp;
13170 struct cleanup *old_chain;
13171 char *addr_string;
13172
13173 expanded.nelts = 1;
13174 expanded.sals = &lsal->sals.sals[i];
13175
13176 addr_string = xstrdup (canonical->addr_string);
13177 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
13178
13179 tp = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
13180 init_breakpoint_sal (&tp->base, gdbarch, expanded,
13181 addr_string, NULL,
13182 cond_string, extra_string,
13183 type_wanted, disposition,
13184 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13185 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13186 canonical->special_display);
13187 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13188 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13189 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13190 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13191 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13192 corresponds to this one */
13193 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13194
13195 install_breakpoint (internal, &tp->base, 0);
13196
13197 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
13198 }
13199 }
13200
13201 static void
13202 strace_marker_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13203 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13204 {
13205 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13206
13207 *sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (s);
13208 if (sals->nelts > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13209 {
13210 sals->sals[0] = sals->sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13211 sals->nelts = 1;
13212 }
13213 else
13214 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13215 }
13216
13217 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13218
13219 static int
13220 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13221 {
13222 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13223 }
13224
13225 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13226 structures. */
13227
13228 void
13229 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13230 {
13231 struct breakpoint *b;
13232
13233 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13234
13235 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13236 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13237 especial culprits.
13238
13239 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13240 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13241 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13242 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13243 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13244 deleted.
13245
13246 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13247 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13248 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13249 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13250 was chosen. */
13251 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13252 return;
13253
13254 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13255 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13256 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13257 {
13258 struct breakpoint *related;
13259 struct watchpoint *w;
13260
13261 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13262 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13263 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13264 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13265 else
13266 w = NULL;
13267 if (w != NULL)
13268 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13269
13270 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13271 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13272 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13273 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13274 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13275 }
13276
13277 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13278 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13279 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13280 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13281 if (bpt->number)
13282 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt);
13283
13284 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13285 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13286
13287 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13288 if (b->next == bpt)
13289 {
13290 b->next = bpt->next;
13291 break;
13292 }
13293
13294 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13295 been freed. */
13296 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13297 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13298 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13299 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13300 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13301 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13302 commands won't work. */
13303
13304 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13305
13306 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13307 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13308 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13309 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13310 might be better design to have location completely
13311 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13312 update_global_location_list (0);
13313
13314 bpt->ops->dtor (bpt);
13315 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13316 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13317 bpt->type = bp_none;
13318 xfree (bpt);
13319 }
13320
13321 static void
13322 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
13323 {
13324 delete_breakpoint (b);
13325 }
13326
13327 struct cleanup *
13328 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
13329 {
13330 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
13331 }
13332
13333 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13334 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13335
13336 static void
13337 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13338 void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
13339 void *),
13340 void *data)
13341 {
13342 struct breakpoint *related;
13343
13344 related = b;
13345 do
13346 {
13347 struct breakpoint *next;
13348
13349 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13350 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13351
13352 if (next == related)
13353 {
13354 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13355 function (related, data);
13356
13357 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13358 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13359 out. */
13360 break;
13361 }
13362 else
13363 function (related, data);
13364
13365 related = next;
13366 }
13367 while (related != b);
13368 }
13369
13370 static void
13371 do_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
13372 {
13373 delete_breakpoint (b);
13374 }
13375
13376 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
13377 delete_breakpoint. */
13378
13379 static void
13380 do_map_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
13381 {
13382 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
13383 }
13384
13385 void
13386 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
13387 {
13388 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13389
13390 dont_repeat ();
13391
13392 if (arg == 0)
13393 {
13394 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
13395
13396 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13397 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13398 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13399 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13400 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13401 {
13402 breaks_to_delete = 1;
13403 break;
13404 }
13405
13406 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
13407 if (!from_tty
13408 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
13409 {
13410 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13411 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13412 delete_breakpoint (b);
13413 }
13414 }
13415 else
13416 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
13417 }
13418
13419 static int
13420 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
13421 {
13422 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
13423 if (!loc->shlib_disabled
13424 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13425 return 0;
13426 return 1;
13427 }
13428
13429 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
13430 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
13431 Null names are ignored. */
13432
13433 static int
13434 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
13435 {
13436 struct bp_location *l;
13437 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
13438 (int (*) (const void *,
13439 const void *)) streq,
13440 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
13441
13442 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
13443 {
13444 const char **slot;
13445 const char *name = l->function_name;
13446
13447 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
13448 if (name == NULL)
13449 continue;
13450
13451 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
13452 INSERT);
13453 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
13454 returns NULL. */
13455 if (*slot != NULL)
13456 {
13457 htab_delete (htab);
13458 return 1;
13459 }
13460 *slot = name;
13461 }
13462
13463 htab_delete (htab);
13464 return 0;
13465 }
13466
13467 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
13468 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
13469 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
13470 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
13471 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
13472 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
13473 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
13474 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
13475 The heuristic is:
13476
13477 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
13478 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
13479 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
13480 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
13481 in the sources, and output a warning.
13482
13483 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
13484 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
13485 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
13486 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
13487 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
13488 warning.
13489
13490 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
13491 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
13492 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
13493 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
13494 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
13495 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
13496 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
13497 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
13498 precisely because it confuses tools). */
13499
13500 static struct symtab_and_line
13501 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
13502 {
13503 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13504 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
13505 CORE_ADDR pc;
13506
13507 pc = sal.pc;
13508 if (sal.line)
13509 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
13510
13511 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
13512 {
13513 if (strcmp (tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id) != 0)
13514 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
13515 b->number,
13516 tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id);
13517
13518 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13519 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
13520 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
13521
13522 return sal;
13523 }
13524
13525 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
13526 by string ID. */
13527 if (!sal.explicit_pc
13528 && sal.line != 0
13529 && sal.symtab != NULL
13530 && tp->static_trace_marker_id != NULL)
13531 {
13532 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers;
13533
13534 markers
13535 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13536
13537 if (!VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
13538 {
13539 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
13540 struct symbol *sym;
13541 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
13542 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13543
13544 tpmarker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, 0);
13545
13546 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13547 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (tpmarker->str_id);
13548
13549 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
13550 "found at previous line number"),
13551 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13552
13553 init_sal (&sal2);
13554
13555 sal2.pc = tpmarker->address;
13556
13557 sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
13558 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
13559 ui_out_text (uiout, "Now in ");
13560 if (sym)
13561 {
13562 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
13563 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
13564 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
13565 }
13566 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", sal2.symtab->filename);
13567 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
13568
13569 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
13570 {
13571 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
13572
13573 if (fullname)
13574 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
13575 }
13576
13577 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", sal2.line);
13578 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
13579
13580 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
13581
13582 xfree (b->loc->source_file);
13583 if (sym)
13584 b->loc->source_file = xstrdup (sal2.symtab->filename);
13585 else
13586 b->loc->source_file = NULL;
13587
13588 xfree (b->addr_string);
13589 b->addr_string = xstrprintf ("%s:%d",
13590 sal2.symtab->filename,
13591 b->loc->line_number);
13592
13593 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
13594 so. */
13595
13596 release_static_tracepoint_marker (tpmarker);
13597 }
13598 }
13599 return sal;
13600 }
13601
13602 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
13603 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
13604
13605 static int
13606 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
13607 {
13608 while (a && b)
13609 {
13610 if (a->address != b->address)
13611 return 0;
13612
13613 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
13614 return 0;
13615
13616 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
13617 return 0;
13618
13619 a = a->next;
13620 b = b->next;
13621 }
13622
13623 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
13624 return 0;
13625
13626 return 1;
13627 }
13628
13629 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software breakpoint)
13630 based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not zero, then B is
13631 a ranged breakpoint. */
13632
13633 void
13634 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
13635 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
13636 struct symtabs_and_lines sals_end)
13637 {
13638 int i;
13639 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
13640
13641 if (sals_end.nelts != 0 && (sals.nelts != 1 || sals_end.nelts != 1))
13642 {
13643 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
13644 location. */
13645 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13646 update_global_location_list (1);
13647 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
13648 "multiple locations found\n"),
13649 b->number);
13650 return;
13651 }
13652
13653 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
13654 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
13655 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
13656 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
13657 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
13658 individual locations. */
13659 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
13660 return;
13661
13662 b->loc = NULL;
13663
13664 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
13665 {
13666 struct bp_location *new_loc;
13667
13668 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sals.sals[i].pspace);
13669
13670 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
13671
13672 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
13673 old symtab. */
13674 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
13675 {
13676 char *s;
13677 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
13678
13679 s = b->cond_string;
13680 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
13681 {
13682 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sals.sals[i].pc,
13683 block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
13684 0);
13685 }
13686 if (e.reason < 0)
13687 {
13688 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
13689 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
13690 b->number, e.message);
13691 new_loc->enabled = 0;
13692 }
13693 }
13694
13695 if (sals_end.nelts)
13696 {
13697 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end.sals[0]);
13698
13699 new_loc->length = end - sals.sals[0].pc + 1;
13700 }
13701 }
13702
13703 /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints. */
13704 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
13705 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
13706
13707 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
13708 breakpoints. */
13709 {
13710 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
13711 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
13712 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
13713 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
13714 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
13715 often enough until a better solution is found. */
13716 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
13717
13718 for (; e; e = e->next)
13719 {
13720 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
13721 {
13722 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
13723 if (have_ambiguous_names)
13724 {
13725 for (; l; l = l->next)
13726 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
13727 {
13728 l->enabled = 0;
13729 break;
13730 }
13731 }
13732 else
13733 {
13734 for (; l; l = l->next)
13735 if (l->function_name
13736 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
13737 {
13738 l->enabled = 0;
13739 break;
13740 }
13741 }
13742 }
13743 }
13744 }
13745
13746 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
13747 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
13748
13749 update_global_location_list (1);
13750 }
13751
13752 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given ADDR_STRING.
13753 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
13754
13755 static struct symtabs_and_lines
13756 addr_string_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, char *addr_string, int *found)
13757 {
13758 char *s;
13759 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
13760 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
13761
13762 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
13763 s = addr_string;
13764
13765 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
13766 {
13767 b->ops->decode_linespec (b, &s, &sals);
13768 }
13769 if (e.reason < 0)
13770 {
13771 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
13772 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
13773 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
13774 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
13775 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
13776 state, then user already saw the message about that
13777 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
13778 errors. */
13779 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
13780 && (b->condition_not_parsed
13781 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
13782 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13783 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
13784 not_found_and_ok = 1;
13785
13786 if (!not_found_and_ok)
13787 {
13788 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
13789 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
13790 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
13791 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
13792 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
13793 which approach is better. */
13794 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13795 throw_exception (e);
13796 }
13797 }
13798
13799 if (e.reason == 0 || e.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
13800 {
13801 int i;
13802
13803 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
13804 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[i]);
13805 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
13806 {
13807 char *cond_string = 0;
13808 int thread = -1;
13809 int task = 0;
13810 char *extra_string = NULL;
13811
13812 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
13813 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
13814 &extra_string);
13815 if (cond_string)
13816 b->cond_string = cond_string;
13817 b->thread = thread;
13818 b->task = task;
13819 if (extra_string)
13820 b->extra_string = extra_string;
13821 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
13822 }
13823
13824 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
13825 sals.sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals.sals[0]);
13826
13827 *found = 1;
13828 }
13829 else
13830 *found = 0;
13831
13832 return sals;
13833 }
13834
13835 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
13836 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
13837 locations. */
13838
13839 static void
13840 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
13841 {
13842 int found;
13843 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, sals_end;
13844 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
13845 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded_end = {0};
13846
13847 sals = addr_string_to_sals (b, b->addr_string, &found);
13848 if (found)
13849 {
13850 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
13851 expanded = sals;
13852 }
13853
13854 if (b->addr_string_range_end)
13855 {
13856 sals_end = addr_string_to_sals (b, b->addr_string_range_end, &found);
13857 if (found)
13858 {
13859 make_cleanup (xfree, sals_end.sals);
13860 expanded_end = sals_end;
13861 }
13862 }
13863
13864 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded, expanded_end);
13865 }
13866
13867 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
13868 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
13869
13870 static void
13871 create_sals_from_address_default (char **arg,
13872 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13873 enum bptype type_wanted,
13874 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
13875 {
13876 parse_breakpoint_sals (arg, canonical);
13877 }
13878
13879 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
13880 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
13881 breakpoint_ops. */
13882
13883 static void
13884 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13885 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13886 struct linespec_sals *lsal,
13887 char *cond_string,
13888 char *extra_string,
13889 enum bptype type_wanted,
13890 enum bpdisp disposition,
13891 int thread,
13892 int task, int ignore_count,
13893 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13894 int from_tty, int enabled,
13895 int internal, unsigned flags)
13896 {
13897 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical, cond_string,
13898 extra_string,
13899 type_wanted, disposition,
13900 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13901 enabled, internal, flags);
13902 }
13903
13904 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
13905 default function for the `decode_linespec' method of breakpoint_ops. */
13906
13907 static void
13908 decode_linespec_default (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13909 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13910 {
13911 struct linespec_result canonical;
13912
13913 init_linespec_result (&canonical);
13914 decode_line_full (s, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
13915 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
13916 &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
13917 b->filter);
13918
13919 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
13920 gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) < 2);
13921
13922 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 0)
13923 {
13924 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
13925
13926 lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0);
13927 *sals = lsal->sals;
13928 /* Arrange it so the destructor does not free the
13929 contents. */
13930 lsal->sals.sals = NULL;
13931 }
13932
13933 destroy_linespec_result (&canonical);
13934 }
13935
13936 /* Prepare the global context for a re-set of breakpoint B. */
13937
13938 static struct cleanup *
13939 prepare_re_set_context (struct breakpoint *b)
13940 {
13941 struct cleanup *cleanups;
13942
13943 input_radix = b->input_radix;
13944 cleanups = save_current_space_and_thread ();
13945 if (b->pspace != NULL)
13946 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
13947 set_language (b->language);
13948
13949 return cleanups;
13950 }
13951
13952 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
13953 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
13954 Unused in this case. */
13955
13956 static int
13957 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
13958 {
13959 /* Get past catch_errs. */
13960 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
13961 struct cleanup *cleanups;
13962
13963 cleanups = prepare_re_set_context (b);
13964 b->ops->re_set (b);
13965 do_cleanups (cleanups);
13966 return 0;
13967 }
13968
13969 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
13970 void
13971 breakpoint_re_set (void)
13972 {
13973 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13974 enum language save_language;
13975 int save_input_radix;
13976 struct cleanup *old_chain;
13977
13978 save_language = current_language->la_language;
13979 save_input_radix = input_radix;
13980 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
13981
13982 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13983 {
13984 /* Format possible error msg. */
13985 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
13986 b->number);
13987 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
13988 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
13989 do_cleanups (cleanups);
13990 }
13991 set_language (save_language);
13992 input_radix = save_input_radix;
13993
13994 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
13995
13996 do_cleanups (old_chain);
13997
13998 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
13999 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
14000 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
14001 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
14002
14003 /* While we're at it, reset the skip list too. */
14004 skip_re_set ();
14005 }
14006 \f
14007 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
14008
14009 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
14010 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
14011 void
14012 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
14013 {
14014 if (b->thread != -1)
14015 {
14016 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
14017 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
14018
14019 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
14020 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
14021 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
14022 as well. */
14023 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
14024 }
14025 }
14026
14027 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14028 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14029 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14030
14031 void
14032 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
14033 {
14034 struct breakpoint *b;
14035
14036 if (count < 0)
14037 count = 0;
14038
14039 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14040 if (b->number == bptnum)
14041 {
14042 if (is_tracepoint (b))
14043 {
14044 if (from_tty && count != 0)
14045 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
14046 bptnum);
14047 return;
14048 }
14049
14050 b->ignore_count = count;
14051 if (from_tty)
14052 {
14053 if (count == 0)
14054 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
14055 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
14056 bptnum);
14057 else if (count == 1)
14058 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
14059 bptnum);
14060 else
14061 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
14062 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
14063 count, bptnum);
14064 }
14065 breakpoints_changed ();
14066 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14067 return;
14068 }
14069
14070 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
14071 }
14072
14073 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
14074
14075 static void
14076 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14077 {
14078 char *p = args;
14079 int num;
14080
14081 if (p == 0)
14082 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
14083
14084 num = get_number (&p);
14085 if (num == 0)
14086 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
14087 if (*p == 0)
14088 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
14089
14090 set_ignore_count (num,
14091 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
14092 from_tty);
14093 if (from_tty)
14094 printf_filtered ("\n");
14095 }
14096 \f
14097 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
14098 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
14099
14100 static void
14101 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
14102 void *),
14103 void *data)
14104 {
14105 int num;
14106 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
14107 int match;
14108 struct get_number_or_range_state state;
14109
14110 if (args == 0)
14111 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
14112
14113 init_number_or_range (&state, args);
14114
14115 while (!state.finished)
14116 {
14117 char *p = state.string;
14118
14119 match = 0;
14120
14121 num = get_number_or_range (&state);
14122 if (num == 0)
14123 {
14124 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
14125 }
14126 else
14127 {
14128 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
14129 if (b->number == num)
14130 {
14131 match = 1;
14132 function (b, data);
14133 break;
14134 }
14135 if (match == 0)
14136 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
14137 }
14138 }
14139 }
14140
14141 static struct bp_location *
14142 find_location_by_number (char *number)
14143 {
14144 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
14145 char *p1;
14146 int bp_num;
14147 int loc_num;
14148 struct breakpoint *b;
14149 struct bp_location *loc;
14150
14151 *dot = '\0';
14152
14153 p1 = number;
14154 bp_num = get_number (&p1);
14155 if (bp_num == 0)
14156 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
14157
14158 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14159 if (b->number == bp_num)
14160 {
14161 break;
14162 }
14163
14164 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
14165 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
14166
14167 p1 = dot+1;
14168 loc_num = get_number (&p1);
14169 if (loc_num == 0)
14170 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
14171
14172 --loc_num;
14173 loc = b->loc;
14174 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
14175 ;
14176 if (!loc)
14177 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
14178
14179 return loc;
14180 }
14181
14182
14183 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14184 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14185 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14186
14187 void
14188 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14189 {
14190 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14191 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14192 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14193 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14194 return;
14195
14196 /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints. */
14197 if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
14198 return;
14199
14200 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14201
14202 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14203 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14204
14205 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14206 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14207 {
14208 struct bp_location *location;
14209
14210 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14211 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14212 }
14213
14214 update_global_location_list (0);
14215
14216 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14217 }
14218
14219 /* A callback for iterate_over_related_breakpoints. */
14220
14221 static void
14222 do_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14223 {
14224 disable_breakpoint (b);
14225 }
14226
14227 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
14228 disable_breakpoint. */
14229
14230 static void
14231 do_map_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14232 {
14233 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
14234 }
14235
14236 static void
14237 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14238 {
14239 if (args == 0)
14240 {
14241 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14242
14243 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14244 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14245 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14246 }
14247 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
14248 {
14249 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
14250 if (loc)
14251 {
14252 if (loc->enabled)
14253 {
14254 loc->enabled = 0;
14255 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14256 }
14257 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14258 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14259 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14260 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14261 }
14262 update_global_location_list (0);
14263 }
14264 else
14265 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
14266 }
14267
14268 static void
14269 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14270 int count)
14271 {
14272 int target_resources_ok;
14273
14274 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14275 {
14276 int i;
14277 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14278 target_resources_ok =
14279 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14280 i + 1, 0);
14281 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14282 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14283 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14284 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14285 }
14286
14287 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14288 {
14289 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14290 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = 0;
14291 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
14292
14293 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
14294 {
14295 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14296
14297 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14298 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14299 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14300 }
14301 if (e.reason < 0)
14302 {
14303 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14304 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14305 bpt->number);
14306 return;
14307 }
14308 }
14309
14310 if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
14311 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14312
14313 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14314
14315 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14316 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14317
14318 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14319 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14320 {
14321 struct bp_location *location;
14322
14323 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14324 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14325 }
14326
14327 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14328 bpt->enable_count = count;
14329 update_global_location_list (1);
14330 breakpoints_changed ();
14331
14332 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14333 }
14334
14335
14336 void
14337 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14338 {
14339 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
14340 }
14341
14342 static void
14343 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg)
14344 {
14345 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14346 }
14347
14348 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
14349 enable_breakpoint. */
14350
14351 static void
14352 do_map_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14353 {
14354 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
14355 }
14356
14357 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
14358 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
14359 in stopping the inferior. */
14360
14361 static void
14362 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14363 {
14364 if (args == 0)
14365 {
14366 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14367
14368 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14369 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14370 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14371 }
14372 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
14373 {
14374 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
14375 if (loc)
14376 {
14377 if (!loc->enabled)
14378 {
14379 loc->enabled = 1;
14380 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14381 }
14382 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14383 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14384 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14385 target_enable_tracepoint (loc);
14386 }
14387 update_global_location_list (1);
14388 }
14389 else
14390 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
14391 }
14392
14393 /* This struct packages up disposition data for application to multiple
14394 breakpoints. */
14395
14396 struct disp_data
14397 {
14398 enum bpdisp disp;
14399 int count;
14400 };
14401
14402 static void
14403 do_enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg)
14404 {
14405 struct disp_data disp_data = *(struct disp_data *) arg;
14406
14407 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_data.disp, disp_data.count);
14408 }
14409
14410 static void
14411 do_map_enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
14412 {
14413 struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, 1 };
14414
14415 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
14416 }
14417
14418 static void
14419 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14420 {
14421 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_once_breakpoint, NULL);
14422 }
14423
14424 static void
14425 do_map_enable_count_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *countptr)
14426 {
14427 struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, *(int *) countptr };
14428
14429 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
14430 }
14431
14432 static void
14433 enable_count_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14434 {
14435 int count = get_number (&args);
14436
14437 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_count_breakpoint, &count);
14438 }
14439
14440 static void
14441 do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
14442 {
14443 struct disp_data disp = { disp_del, 1 };
14444
14445 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
14446 }
14447
14448 static void
14449 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14450 {
14451 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
14452 }
14453 \f
14454 static void
14455 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
14456 {
14457 }
14458
14459 static void
14460 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
14461 {
14462 }
14463
14464 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
14465 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
14466 GDB itself. */
14467
14468 static void
14469 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (CORE_ADDR addr, int len,
14470 const bfd_byte *data)
14471 {
14472 struct breakpoint *bp;
14473
14474 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
14475 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
14476 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
14477 {
14478 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
14479
14480 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val)
14481 {
14482 struct bp_location *loc;
14483
14484 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14485 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
14486 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
14487 && addr + len > loc->address)
14488 {
14489 value_free (wp->val);
14490 wp->val = NULL;
14491 wp->val_valid = 0;
14492 }
14493 }
14494 }
14495 }
14496
14497 /* Use the last displayed codepoint's values, or nothing
14498 if they aren't valid. */
14499
14500 struct symtabs_and_lines
14501 decode_line_spec_1 (char *string, int flags)
14502 {
14503 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
14504
14505 if (string == 0)
14506 error (_("Empty line specification."));
14507 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
14508 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, flags,
14509 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
14510 get_last_displayed_line ());
14511 else
14512 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, flags, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0);
14513 if (*string)
14514 error (_("Junk at end of line specification: %s"), string);
14515 return sals;
14516 }
14517
14518 /* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC. Return an
14519 identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
14520 In general, places which call this should be using something on the
14521 breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
14522 someday. */
14523
14524 void *
14525 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14526 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
14527 {
14528 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
14529
14530 bp_tgt = XZALLOC (struct bp_target_info);
14531
14532 bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
14533 bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
14534
14535 if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
14536 {
14537 /* Could not insert the breakpoint. */
14538 xfree (bp_tgt);
14539 return NULL;
14540 }
14541
14542 return bp_tgt;
14543 }
14544
14545 /* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by
14546 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint. */
14547
14548 int
14549 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
14550 {
14551 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
14552 int ret;
14553
14554 ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
14555 xfree (bp_tgt);
14556
14557 return ret;
14558 }
14559
14560 /* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single
14561 stepping. */
14562
14563 static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
14564 static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
14565
14566 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
14567
14568 void
14569 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14570 struct address_space *aspace,
14571 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
14572 {
14573 void **bpt_p;
14574
14575 if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
14576 {
14577 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
14578 single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
14579 }
14580 else
14581 {
14582 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
14583 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
14584 single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
14585 }
14586
14587 /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would
14588 be to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on
14589 the breakpoint chain. That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint.
14590 We could adjust the addresses each time they were needed. Doing
14591 this requires corresponding changes elsewhere where single step
14592 breakpoints are handled, however. So, for now, we use this. */
14593
14594 *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
14595 if (*bpt_p == NULL)
14596 error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
14597 paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
14598 }
14599
14600 /* Check if the breakpoints used for software single stepping
14601 were inserted or not. */
14602
14603 int
14604 single_step_breakpoints_inserted (void)
14605 {
14606 return (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL
14607 || single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL);
14608 }
14609
14610 /* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step. */
14611
14612 void
14613 remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
14614 {
14615 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
14616
14617 /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
14618 call. */
14619 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
14620 single_step_breakpoints[0]);
14621 single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
14622 single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
14623
14624 if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
14625 {
14626 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
14627 single_step_breakpoints[1]);
14628 single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
14629 single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
14630 }
14631 }
14632
14633 /* Delete software single step breakpoints without removing them from
14634 the inferior. This is intended to be used if the inferior's address
14635 space where they were inserted is already gone, e.g. after exit or
14636 exec. */
14637
14638 void
14639 cancel_single_step_breakpoints (void)
14640 {
14641 int i;
14642
14643 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
14644 if (single_step_breakpoints[i])
14645 {
14646 xfree (single_step_breakpoints[i]);
14647 single_step_breakpoints[i] = NULL;
14648 single_step_gdbarch[i] = NULL;
14649 }
14650 }
14651
14652 /* Detach software single-step breakpoints from INFERIOR_PTID without
14653 removing them. */
14654
14655 static void
14656 detach_single_step_breakpoints (void)
14657 {
14658 int i;
14659
14660 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
14661 if (single_step_breakpoints[i])
14662 target_remove_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[i],
14663 single_step_breakpoints[i]);
14664 }
14665
14666 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
14667 PC. */
14668
14669 static int
14670 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
14671 CORE_ADDR pc)
14672 {
14673 int i;
14674
14675 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
14676 {
14677 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
14678 if (bp_tgt
14679 && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
14680 bp_tgt->placed_address,
14681 aspace, pc))
14682 return 1;
14683 }
14684
14685 return 0;
14686 }
14687
14688 /* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
14689 non-zero otherwise. */
14690 static int
14691 is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
14692 {
14693 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
14694 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
14695 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
14696 return 1;
14697 else
14698 return 0;
14699 }
14700
14701 int
14702 catch_syscall_enabled (void)
14703 {
14704 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data
14705 = get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
14706
14707 return inf_data->total_syscalls_count != 0;
14708 }
14709
14710 int
14711 catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
14712 {
14713 struct breakpoint *bp;
14714
14715 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
14716 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
14717 {
14718 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) bp;
14719
14720 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
14721 {
14722 int i, iter;
14723 for (i = 0;
14724 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
14725 i++)
14726 if (syscall_number == iter)
14727 return 1;
14728 }
14729 else
14730 return 1;
14731 }
14732
14733 return 0;
14734 }
14735
14736 /* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
14737 static VEC (char_ptr) *
14738 catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
14739 char *text, char *word)
14740 {
14741 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
14742 VEC (char_ptr) *retlist
14743 = (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, text, word);
14744
14745 xfree (list);
14746 return retlist;
14747 }
14748
14749 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
14750
14751 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
14752 static void
14753 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
14754 {
14755 tracepoint_count = num;
14756 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
14757 }
14758
14759 static void
14760 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
14761 {
14762 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14763 const char *arg_cp = arg;
14764
14765 if (arg && probe_linespec_to_ops (&arg_cp))
14766 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
14767 else
14768 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14769
14770 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14771 arg,
14772 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
14773 0 /* tempflag */,
14774 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14775 0 /* Ignore count */,
14776 pending_break_support,
14777 ops,
14778 from_tty,
14779 1 /* enabled */,
14780 0 /* internal */, 0))
14781 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
14782 }
14783
14784 static void
14785 ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
14786 {
14787 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14788 arg,
14789 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
14790 0 /* tempflag */,
14791 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14792 0 /* Ignore count */,
14793 pending_break_support,
14794 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14795 from_tty,
14796 1 /* enabled */,
14797 0 /* internal */, 0))
14798 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
14799 }
14800
14801 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
14802
14803 static void
14804 strace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
14805 {
14806 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14807
14808 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
14809 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
14810 if (arg && strncmp (arg, "-m", 2) == 0 && isspace (arg[2]))
14811 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
14812 else
14813 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14814
14815 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14816 arg,
14817 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
14818 0 /* tempflag */,
14819 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14820 0 /* Ignore count */,
14821 pending_break_support,
14822 ops,
14823 from_tty,
14824 1 /* enabled */,
14825 0 /* internal */, 0))
14826 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
14827 }
14828
14829 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
14830 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
14831
14832 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
14833 static int next_cmd;
14834
14835 static char *
14836 read_uploaded_action (void)
14837 {
14838 char *rslt;
14839
14840 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, this_utp->cmd_strings, next_cmd, rslt);
14841
14842 next_cmd++;
14843
14844 return rslt;
14845 }
14846
14847 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
14848 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
14849 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
14850 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
14851 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
14852
14853 struct tracepoint *
14854 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
14855 {
14856 char *addr_str, small_buf[100];
14857 struct tracepoint *tp;
14858
14859 if (utp->at_string)
14860 addr_str = utp->at_string;
14861 else
14862 {
14863 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
14864 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
14865 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
14866 user. */
14867 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
14868 "source location, using raw address"),
14869 utp->number);
14870 sprintf (small_buf, "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
14871 addr_str = small_buf;
14872 }
14873
14874 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
14875 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
14876 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
14877 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
14878 utp->number);
14879
14880 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14881 addr_str,
14882 utp->cond_string, -1, NULL,
14883 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
14884 0 /* tempflag */,
14885 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
14886 0 /* Ignore count */,
14887 pending_break_support,
14888 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14889 0 /* from_tty */,
14890 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
14891 0 /* internal */,
14892 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
14893 return NULL;
14894
14895 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
14896
14897 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
14898 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
14899 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
14900
14901 if (utp->pass > 0)
14902 {
14903 sprintf (small_buf, "%d %d", utp->pass, tp->base.number);
14904
14905 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
14906 }
14907
14908 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
14909 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
14910 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
14911 function. */
14912 if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->cmd_strings))
14913 {
14914 struct command_line *cmd_list;
14915
14916 this_utp = utp;
14917 next_cmd = 0;
14918
14919 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL, NULL);
14920
14921 breakpoint_set_commands (&tp->base, cmd_list);
14922 }
14923 else if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->actions)
14924 || !VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->step_actions))
14925 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
14926 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
14927 utp->number);
14928
14929 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
14930 tp->base.hit_count = utp->hit_count;
14931 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
14932
14933 return tp;
14934 }
14935
14936 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
14937 omitted. */
14938
14939 static void
14940 tracepoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
14941 {
14942 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14943 int num_printed;
14944
14945 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
14946
14947 if (num_printed == 0)
14948 {
14949 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14950 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
14951 else
14952 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
14953 }
14954
14955 default_collect_info ();
14956 }
14957
14958 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
14959 Not supported by all targets. */
14960 static void
14961 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14962 {
14963 enable_command (args, from_tty);
14964 }
14965
14966 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
14967 Not supported by all targets. */
14968 static void
14969 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14970 {
14971 disable_command (args, from_tty);
14972 }
14973
14974 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
14975 static void
14976 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
14977 {
14978 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14979
14980 dont_repeat ();
14981
14982 if (arg == 0)
14983 {
14984 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14985
14986 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
14987 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
14988 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
14989 argument. */
14990 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14991 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14992 {
14993 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14994 break;
14995 }
14996
14997 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14998 if (!from_tty
14999 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
15000 {
15001 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15002 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
15003 delete_breakpoint (b);
15004 }
15005 }
15006 else
15007 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
15008 }
15009
15010 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
15011
15012 static void
15013 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
15014 {
15015 tp->pass_count = count;
15016 observer_notify_tracepoint_modified (tp->base.number);
15017 if (from_tty)
15018 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
15019 tp->base.number, count);
15020 }
15021
15022 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
15023
15024 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
15025 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
15026 Also accepts special argument "all". */
15027
15028 static void
15029 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15030 {
15031 struct tracepoint *t1;
15032 unsigned int count;
15033
15034 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
15035 error (_("passcount command requires an "
15036 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
15037
15038 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
15039
15040 while (*args && isspace ((int) *args))
15041 args++;
15042
15043 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
15044 {
15045 struct breakpoint *b;
15046
15047 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
15048 if (*args)
15049 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
15050
15051 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15052 {
15053 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15054 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15055 }
15056 }
15057 else if (*args == '\0')
15058 {
15059 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL, 1);
15060 if (t1)
15061 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15062 }
15063 else
15064 {
15065 struct get_number_or_range_state state;
15066
15067 init_number_or_range (&state, args);
15068 while (!state.finished)
15069 {
15070 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &state, 1);
15071 if (t1)
15072 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15073 }
15074 }
15075 }
15076
15077 struct tracepoint *
15078 get_tracepoint (int num)
15079 {
15080 struct breakpoint *t;
15081
15082 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15083 if (t->number == num)
15084 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15085
15086 return NULL;
15087 }
15088
15089 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
15090 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
15091 reconnecting). */
15092
15093 struct tracepoint *
15094 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
15095 {
15096 struct breakpoint *b;
15097
15098 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15099 {
15100 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15101
15102 if (t->number_on_target == num)
15103 return t;
15104 }
15105
15106 return NULL;
15107 }
15108
15109 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
15110 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
15111 If OPTIONAL_P is true, then if the argument is missing, the most
15112 recent tracepoint (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
15113 struct tracepoint *
15114 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg,
15115 struct get_number_or_range_state *state,
15116 int optional_p)
15117 {
15118 extern int tracepoint_count;
15119 struct breakpoint *t;
15120 int tpnum;
15121 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
15122
15123 if (state)
15124 {
15125 gdb_assert (!state->finished);
15126 tpnum = get_number_or_range (state);
15127 }
15128 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
15129 {
15130 if (optional_p)
15131 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
15132 else
15133 error_no_arg (_("tracepoint number"));
15134 }
15135 else
15136 tpnum = get_number (arg);
15137
15138 if (tpnum <= 0)
15139 {
15140 if (instring && *instring)
15141 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
15142 instring);
15143 else
15144 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint argument missing "
15145 "and no previous tracepoint\n"));
15146 return NULL;
15147 }
15148
15149 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15150 if (t->number == tpnum)
15151 {
15152 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15153 }
15154
15155 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
15156 return NULL;
15157 }
15158
15159 void
15160 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
15161 {
15162 if (b->thread != -1)
15163 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
15164
15165 if (b->task != 0)
15166 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
15167
15168 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
15169 }
15170
15171 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
15172 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
15173 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
15174 non-zero. */
15175
15176 static void
15177 save_breakpoints (char *filename, int from_tty,
15178 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
15179 {
15180 struct breakpoint *tp;
15181 int any = 0;
15182 char *pathname;
15183 struct cleanup *cleanup;
15184 struct ui_file *fp;
15185 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
15186
15187 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
15188 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
15189
15190 /* See if we have anything to save. */
15191 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15192 {
15193 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15194 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15195 continue;
15196
15197 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15198 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15199 continue;
15200
15201 any = 1;
15202
15203 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
15204 {
15205 extra_trace_bits = 1;
15206
15207 /* We can stop searching. */
15208 break;
15209 }
15210 }
15211
15212 if (!any)
15213 {
15214 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
15215 return;
15216 }
15217
15218 pathname = tilde_expand (filename);
15219 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, pathname);
15220 fp = gdb_fopen (pathname, "w");
15221 if (!fp)
15222 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15223 filename, safe_strerror (errno));
15224 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (fp);
15225
15226 if (extra_trace_bits)
15227 save_trace_state_variables (fp);
15228
15229 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15230 {
15231 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15232 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15233 continue;
15234
15235 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15236 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15237 continue;
15238
15239 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, fp);
15240
15241 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15242 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15243 instead. */
15244
15245 if (tp->cond_string)
15246 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15247
15248 if (tp->ignore_count)
15249 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15250
15251 if (tp->commands)
15252 {
15253 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
15254
15255 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " commands\n");
15256
15257 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, fp);
15258 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
15259 {
15260 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands->commands, 2);
15261 }
15262 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, NULL);
15263
15264 if (ex.reason < 0)
15265 throw_exception (ex);
15266
15267 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " end\n");
15268 }
15269
15270 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15271 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable\n");
15272
15273 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15274 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15275 special, and not user visible. */
15276 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15277 {
15278 struct bp_location *loc;
15279 int n = 1;
15280
15281 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
15282 if (!loc->enabled)
15283 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15284 }
15285 }
15286
15287 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15288 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15289
15290 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15291 if (from_tty)
15292 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), filename);
15293 }
15294
15295 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15296
15297 static void
15298 save_breakpoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15299 {
15300 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15301 }
15302
15303 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15304
15305 static void
15306 save_tracepoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15307 {
15308 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15309 }
15310
15311 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15312
15313 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
15314 all_tracepoints (void)
15315 {
15316 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
15317 struct breakpoint *tp;
15318
15319 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
15320 {
15321 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
15322 }
15323
15324 return tp_vec;
15325 }
15326
15327 \f
15328 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15329 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15330 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15331 command. */
15332 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15333 command" [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15334 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
15335 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
15336 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
15337 If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
15338 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15339 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15340 \n\
15341 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15342 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15343 \n\
15344 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15345 conditions are different.\n\
15346 \n\
15347 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15348
15349 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15350 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15351
15352 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15353 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15354
15355 void
15356 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
15357 void (*sfunc) (char *args, int from_tty,
15358 struct cmd_list_element *command),
15359 completer_ftype *completer,
15360 void *user_data_catch,
15361 void *user_data_tcatch)
15362 {
15363 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15364
15365 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
15366 &catch_cmdlist);
15367 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15368 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15369 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15370
15371 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
15372 &tcatch_cmdlist);
15373 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15374 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15375 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15376 }
15377
15378 static void
15379 clear_syscall_counts (struct inferior *inf)
15380 {
15381 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data
15382 = get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (inf);
15383
15384 inf_data->total_syscalls_count = 0;
15385 inf_data->any_syscall_count = 0;
15386 VEC_free (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts);
15387 }
15388
15389 static void
15390 save_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15391 {
15392 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
15393 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
15394 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", -1, gdb_stdout);
15395 }
15396
15397 struct breakpoint *
15398 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
15399 void *data)
15400 {
15401 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15402
15403 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15404 {
15405 if ((*callback) (b, data))
15406 return b;
15407 }
15408
15409 return NULL;
15410 }
15411
15412 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15413 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15414
15415 static int
15416 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15417 {
15418 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15419 non-inline function. */
15420 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15421 return 1;
15422
15423 return 0;
15424 }
15425
15426 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15427 have been inlined. */
15428
15429 int
15430 pc_at_non_inline_function (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15431 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15432 {
15433 struct breakpoint *b;
15434 struct bp_location *bl;
15435
15436 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
15437 {
15438 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15439 continue;
15440
15441 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
15442 {
15443 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15444 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15445 return 1;
15446 }
15447 }
15448
15449 return 0;
15450 }
15451
15452 void
15453 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15454 {
15455 static int initialized = 0;
15456
15457 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15458
15459 if (initialized)
15460 return;
15461 initialized = 1;
15462
15463 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15464 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15465 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
15466 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15467 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15468 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15469 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
15470 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
15471 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
15472 ops->create_sals_from_address = bkpt_create_sals_from_address;
15473 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
15474 ops->decode_linespec = bkpt_decode_linespec;
15475
15476 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
15477 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15478 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15479 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15480 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15481 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15482 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15483 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
15484
15485 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
15486 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
15487 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15488 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
15489 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
15490 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
15491 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
15492 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
15493 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
15494 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
15495
15496 /* Internal breakpoints. */
15497 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
15498 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15499 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
15500 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
15501 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
15502 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
15503
15504 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
15505 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15506 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15507 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
15508 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
15509 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
15510 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
15511
15512 /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception. */
15513 ops = &longjmp_breakpoint_ops;
15514 *ops = momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15515 ops->dtor = longjmp_bkpt_dtor;
15516
15517 /* Probe breakpoints. */
15518 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15519 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15520 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
15521 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
15522 ops->create_sals_from_address = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_address;
15523 ops->decode_linespec = bkpt_probe_decode_linespec;
15524
15525 /* GNU v3 exception catchpoints. */
15526 ops = &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops;
15527 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15528 ops->print_it = print_it_exception_catchpoint;
15529 ops->print_one = print_one_exception_catchpoint;
15530 ops->print_mention = print_mention_exception_catchpoint;
15531 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_exception_catchpoint;
15532
15533 /* Watchpoints. */
15534 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15535 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15536 ops->dtor = dtor_watchpoint;
15537 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
15538 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
15539 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
15540 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
15541 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
15542 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
15543 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
15544 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
15545 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
15546 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
15547
15548 /* Masked watchpoints. */
15549 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15550 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15551 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
15552 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
15553 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
15554 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
15555 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
15556 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
15557 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
15558 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
15559
15560 /* Tracepoints. */
15561 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15562 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15563 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
15564 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
15565 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
15566 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
15567 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
15568 ops->create_sals_from_address = tracepoint_create_sals_from_address;
15569 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
15570 ops->decode_linespec = tracepoint_decode_linespec;
15571
15572 /* Probe tracepoints. */
15573 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15574 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15575 ops->create_sals_from_address = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_address;
15576 ops->decode_linespec = tracepoint_probe_decode_linespec;
15577
15578 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
15579 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15580 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15581 ops->create_sals_from_address = strace_marker_create_sals_from_address;
15582 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
15583 ops->decode_linespec = strace_marker_decode_linespec;
15584
15585 /* Fork catchpoints. */
15586 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
15587 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15588 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
15589 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
15590 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
15591 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
15592 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
15593 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
15594 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
15595
15596 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
15597 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
15598 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15599 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
15600 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
15601 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
15602 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
15603 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
15604 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
15605 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
15606
15607 /* Exec catchpoints. */
15608 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
15609 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15610 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exec;
15611 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
15612 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
15613 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
15614 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
15615 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
15616 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
15617 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
15618
15619 /* Syscall catchpoints. */
15620 ops = &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops;
15621 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15622 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_syscall;
15623 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_syscall;
15624 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_syscall;
15625 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall;
15626 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_syscall;
15627 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_syscall;
15628 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_syscall;
15629 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_syscall;
15630
15631 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
15632 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
15633 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15634 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_solib;
15635 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
15636 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
15637 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
15638 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
15639 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
15640 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
15641 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
15642 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
15643
15644 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
15645 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15646 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15647 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15648 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15649 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15650 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
15651 }
15652
15653 void
15654 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
15655 {
15656 struct cmd_list_element *c;
15657
15658 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
15659
15660 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
15661 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
15662 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
15663
15664 breakpoint_objfile_key
15665 = register_objfile_data_with_cleanup (NULL, free_breakpoint_probes);
15666
15667 catch_syscall_inferior_data
15668 = register_inferior_data_with_cleanup (catch_syscall_inferior_data_cleanup);
15669
15670 breakpoint_chain = 0;
15671 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
15672 before a breakpoint is set. */
15673 breakpoint_count = 0;
15674
15675 tracepoint_count = 0;
15676
15677 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
15678 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
15679 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
15680 if (xdb_commands)
15681 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
15682
15683 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
15684 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
15685 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
15686 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
15687 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
15688 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
15689 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
15690 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
15691
15692 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
15693 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
15694 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
15695 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
15696 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
15697
15698 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
15699 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
15700 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15701 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
15702 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
15703 \n"
15704 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
15705 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15706
15707 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
15708 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15709 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
15710 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
15711 \n"
15712 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
15713 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15714
15715 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
15716 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15717 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15718 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
15719 \n"
15720 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
15721 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15722
15723 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15724 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15725 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15726 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
15727 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15728 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
15729 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15730 if (xdb_commands)
15731 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15732 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15733 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15734 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
15735 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15736 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
15737
15738 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15739
15740 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15741 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15742 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15743 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15744 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
15745 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
15746
15747 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15748 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15749 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15750 &enablebreaklist);
15751
15752 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15753 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15754 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15755 &enablebreaklist);
15756
15757 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15758 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15759 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15760 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15761 &enablebreaklist);
15762
15763 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15764 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15765 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15766 &enablelist);
15767
15768 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15769 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15770 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15771 &enablelist);
15772
15773 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15774 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15775 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15776 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15777 &enablelist);
15778
15779 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
15780 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15781 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15782 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15783 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
15784 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15785 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15786 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15787 if (xdb_commands)
15788 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
15789 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15790 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15791 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15792 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."));
15793
15794 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
15795 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15796 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15797 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15798 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
15799 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
15800 &disablelist);
15801
15802 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15803 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15804 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15805 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15806 \n\
15807 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
15808 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
15809 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
15810 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15811 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15812 if (xdb_commands)
15813 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15814 Delete some breakpoints.\n\
15815 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15816 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
15817
15818 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
15819 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15820 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15821 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15822 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
15823 &deletelist);
15824
15825 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
15826 Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
15827 Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
15828 If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
15829 If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
15830 If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
15831 \n\
15832 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
15833 is executing in.\n\
15834 \n\
15835 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
15836 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
15837
15838 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
15839 Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
15840 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
15841 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15842
15843 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
15844 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
15845 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
15846 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
15847
15848 if (xdb_commands)
15849 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
15850
15851 if (dbx_commands)
15852 {
15853 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
15854 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
15855 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
15856 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
15857 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
15858 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
15859 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
15860 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
15861 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15862 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15863 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15864 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15865 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15866 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15867 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15868 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15869 \n\
15870 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15871 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15872 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15873 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15874 breakpoint set."));
15875 }
15876
15877 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
15878 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
15879 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15880 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15881 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15882 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15883 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15884 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15885 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15886 \n\
15887 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15888 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15889 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15890 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15891 breakpoint set."));
15892
15893 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
15894
15895 if (xdb_commands)
15896 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
15897 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15898 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15899 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15900 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15901 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15902 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15903 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15904 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15905 \n\
15906 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15907 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15908 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15909 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15910 breakpoint set."));
15911
15912 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
15913 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15914 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15915 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15916 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15917 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
15918 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
15919 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
15920 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
15921 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15922 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15923 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15924 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15925 \n\
15926 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15927 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15928 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15929 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15930 breakpoint set."),
15931 &maintenanceinfolist);
15932
15933 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
15934 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
15935 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
15936 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15937
15938 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
15939 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
15940 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
15941 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15942
15943 /* Add catch and tcatch sub-commands. */
15944 add_catch_command ("catch", _("\
15945 Catch an exception, when caught."),
15946 catch_catch_command,
15947 NULL,
15948 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15949 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15950 add_catch_command ("throw", _("\
15951 Catch an exception, when thrown."),
15952 catch_throw_command,
15953 NULL,
15954 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15955 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15956 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
15957 catch_fork_command_1,
15958 NULL,
15959 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
15960 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
15961 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
15962 catch_fork_command_1,
15963 NULL,
15964 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
15965 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
15966 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
15967 catch_exec_command_1,
15968 NULL,
15969 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15970 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15971 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
15972 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
15973 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15974 catch_load_command_1,
15975 NULL,
15976 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15977 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15978 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
15979 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
15980 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15981 catch_unload_command_1,
15982 NULL,
15983 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15984 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15985 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
15986 Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
15987 Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
15988 are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
15989 Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
15990 (if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
15991 catch_syscall_command_1,
15992 catch_syscall_completer,
15993 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15994 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15995
15996 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
15997 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15998 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15999 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16000 an expression changes.\n\
16001 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16002 the memory to which it refers."));
16003 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16004
16005 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
16006 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16007 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16008 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16009 an expression is read.\n\
16010 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16011 the memory to which it refers."));
16012 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16013
16014 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
16015 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16016 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16017 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16018 an expression is either read or written.\n\
16019 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16020 the memory to which it refers."));
16021 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16022
16023 add_info ("watchpoints", watchpoints_info, _("\
16024 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
16025
16026 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
16027 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
16028 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
16029 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
16030 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
16031 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
16032 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
16033 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
16034 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
16035 hardware.)"),
16036 NULL,
16037 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
16038 &setlist, &showlist);
16039
16040 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
16041
16042 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
16043
16044 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
16045 Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
16046 \n"
16047 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
16048 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16049 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16050
16051 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
16052 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16053 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16054 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16055
16056 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
16057 Set a fast tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
16058 \n"
16059 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
16060 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16061 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16062
16063 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
16064 Set a static tracepoint at specified line, function or marker.\n\
16065 \n\
16066 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
16067 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, \"*\" and an address,\n\
16068 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\
16069 If a line number is specified, probe the marker at start of code\n\
16070 for that line. If a function is specified, probe the marker at start\n\
16071 of code for that function. If an address is specified, probe the marker\n\
16072 at that exact address. If a marker id is specified, probe the marker\n\
16073 with that name. With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of\n\
16074 the selected stack frame.\n\
16075 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
16076 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
16077 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
16078 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
16079 \n\
16080 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
16081 \n\
16082 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
16083 conditions are different.\n\
16084 \n\
16085 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
16086 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16087 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16088
16089 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
16090 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
16091 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
16092 last tracepoint set."));
16093
16094 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
16095
16096 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
16097 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
16098 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16099 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
16100 &deletelist);
16101
16102 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
16103 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
16104 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16105 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
16106 &disablelist);
16107 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
16108
16109 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
16110 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
16111 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16112 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
16113 &enablelist);
16114 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
16115
16116 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
16117 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
16118 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
16119 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
16120 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
16121
16122 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
16123 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
16124 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
16125 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16126
16127 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
16128 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
16129 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
16130 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
16131 session to restore them."),
16132 &save_cmdlist);
16133 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16134
16135 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
16136 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
16137 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
16138 &save_cmdlist);
16139 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16140
16141 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
16142 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
16143
16144 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16145 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16146 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16147 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16148 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
16149 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
16150 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16151 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16152 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16153 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16154 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
16155 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
16156
16157 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
16158 &pending_break_support, _("\
16159 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16160 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16161 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
16162 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
16163 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
16164 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
16165 NULL,
16166 show_pending_break_support,
16167 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16168 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16169
16170 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
16171
16172 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
16173 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
16174 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16175 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16176 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
16177 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
16178 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
16179 NULL,
16180 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
16181 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16182 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16183
16184 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
16185 always_inserted_enums, &always_inserted_mode, _("\
16186 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16187 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16188 When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
16189 resumed, and removed when execution stops. When this mode is on,\n\
16190 breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
16191 deletes the breakpoint. When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
16192 the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
16193 In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
16194 behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
16195 inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
16196 NULL,
16197 &show_always_inserted_mode,
16198 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16199 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16200
16201 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
16202 condition_evaluation_enums,
16203 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
16204 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16205 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16206 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
16207 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
16208 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
16209 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
16210 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
16211 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
16212 be set to \"gdb\""),
16213 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
16214 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
16215 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16216 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16217
16218 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
16219 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
16220 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
16221 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
16222 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
16223 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
16224 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
16225 or the start of the range\n\
16226 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
16227 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
16228 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
16229 \n\
16230 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
16231 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
16232 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
16233
16234 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
16235 Set a dynamic printf at specified line or function.\n\
16236 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
16237 location may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
16238 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
16239 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
16240 "));
16241 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16242
16243 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
16244 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
16245 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16246 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16247 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
16248 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
16249 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
16250 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
16251 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
16252 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
16253 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16254 &setlist, &showlist);
16255
16256 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
16257 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
16258 &dprintf_function, _("\
16259 Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16260 Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16261 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16262 &setlist, &showlist);
16263
16264 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
16265 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
16266 &dprintf_channel, _("\
16267 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16268 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16269 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16270 &setlist, &showlist);
16271
16272 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
16273
16274 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
16275 }
This page took 0.454745 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.